blob: b9e6e8067bc8c19539d2566f0308c8e4b2cf5798 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreaue9797962022-05-08 11:44:15 +02006 2022/05/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100729before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
730use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
731next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
732existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200733
734 Example:
735
736 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
737
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100738 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200739
740 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
743file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200744
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
746 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
747
748* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
749 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
750 directory.
751
752* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 processes, separated by semicolons.
756
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500757* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200758 CLI, separated by semicolons.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200816Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
817See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
818
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200819The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
820expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100821
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
823 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200825 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530826 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
827 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200828 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
829 from left to right until one returns false
830 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
831 from right to left until one returns true
832
833Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
834operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200835
836The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
837
838 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
839 exists, regardless of its contents
840
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200841 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
842 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
843 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
844
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200845 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
846 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
847
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200848 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
849 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
850 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
851 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
852
853 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
854 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
855 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
856 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
857
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200858Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200860 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
861 listen mwcli_px
862 bind :1111
863 ...
864 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
867 bind :80
868 .endif
869
870 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200872 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200873 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200874 .endif
875
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200876 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200877 bind :443 ssl crt ...
878 .endif
879
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200880 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
881 profiling.memory on
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200884 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
885 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
886 .endif
887
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200888Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100889
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200890 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100891 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
892 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
893 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
894
895Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
896"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
897fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
898provide advice to the user.
899
900Example:
901
902 .if "${A}"
903 .if "${B}"
904 .notice "A=1, B=1"
905 .elif "${C}"
906 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
907 .elif "${D}"
908 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
909 .else
910 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
911 .endif
912 .else
913 .notice "A=0"
914 .endif
915
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200916 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
917 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
918
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100919
9202.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200921----------------
922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100923Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
925otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
926numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
927for every keyword. Supported units are :
928
929 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
930 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
931 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
932 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
933 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
934 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
935
936
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009372.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200938-------------
939
940 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
941 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
942 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
943 global
944 daemon
945 maxconn 256
946
947 defaults
948 mode http
949 timeout connect 5000ms
950 timeout client 50000ms
951 timeout server 50000ms
952
953 frontend http-in
954 bind *:80
955 default_backend servers
956
957 backend servers
958 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
959
960
961 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
962 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
963 global
964 daemon
965 maxconn 256
966
967 defaults
968 mode http
969 timeout connect 5000ms
970 timeout client 50000ms
971 timeout server 50000ms
972
973 listen http-in
974 bind *:80
975 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
976
977
978Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
979
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100980 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200981
982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984--------------------
985
986Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
987are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
988of them have command-line equivalents.
989
990The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
991
992 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200995 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200996 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
1002 - deviceatlas-separator
1003 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001006 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001008 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001010 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001011 - h1-case-adjust
1012 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001013 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001014 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001015 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001016 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001017 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001020 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001021 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001022 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001023 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001024 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001025 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001027 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001029 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030 - presetenv
1031 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - uid
1033 - ulimit-n
1034 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001035 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001036 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001038 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001040 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001041 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-bind-options
1043 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001044 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-server-options
1046 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001047 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001048 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001049 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001051 - 51degrees-data-file
1052 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001053 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001054 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-data-file
1056 - wurfl-information-list
1057 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001058 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001059 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001062 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001063 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001065 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001066 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001067 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001068 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001069 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001070 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001071 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001073 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001074 - noepoll
1075 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001076 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001078 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001079 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001080 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001081 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001082 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001083 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001084 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001085 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001086 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001087 - tune.buffers.limit
1088 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001090 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001091 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001092 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001093 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001094 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001095 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001096 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001097 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001098 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001099 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001101 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001102 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1103 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001104 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001105 - tune.maxaccept
1106 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001107 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001108 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001109 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001110 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1111 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02001112 - tune.quic.conn-buf-limit
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001113 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1114 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001115 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001116 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001117 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001118 - tune.sndbuf.client
1119 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001120 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001121 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1122 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001123 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001124 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1125 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001126 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001127 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001128 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1129 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001130 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001131 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001132 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1133 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1134 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001135 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1136 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001140 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
1142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011433.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144------------------------------------
1145
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001146ca-base <dir>
1147 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001148 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1149 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1150 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152chroot <jail dir>
1153 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1154 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1155 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1156 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1157 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001159
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001160close-spread-time <time>
1161 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1162 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1163 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1164 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1165 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1166 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1167 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1168 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001169 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1170 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1171 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1172 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1173 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001174
1175 Arguments :
1176 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001177 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1178 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001179
1180 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1181 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1182 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1183
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001184 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001185
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001187 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001188 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1189 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1190 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1191 set. These sets have the format
1192
1193 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1194
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001195 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1196 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001197 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001198 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001199 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1200 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001201 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1202 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1203 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1204 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1205 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1206 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1207 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1208 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1209 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1210 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001211
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001212 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1213 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1214 on the machine's word size.
1215
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001216 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001217 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1218 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1219 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1220 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1221 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1222 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001223
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001224 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1225 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1226 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1227 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001228
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001229 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001230 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1231 # first 4 CPUs
1232
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001233 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1234 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001235 # word size.
1236
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001237 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1238 # and so on.
1239 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1240 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1242
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001243 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1244 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1245 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1246 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001247
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001248 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1249 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1250 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001251
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001252crt-base <dir>
1253 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001254 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1255 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001256
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001257daemon
1258 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1259 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001260 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1261 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001262
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001263default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001264 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001265 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1266 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1267 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1268 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1269 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1270 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1271 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1272 not start with a slash ('/'):
1273 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1274 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1275
1276 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1277 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1278 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1279 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1280 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1281 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1282 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1283 each of them.
1284
1285 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1286 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1287 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1288 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1289 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1290 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1291 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1292 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1293
1294 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1295 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001296 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001297 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1298 made easily relocatable.
1299
1300 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1301 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1302 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1303 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1304 consistent across all configuration files.
1305
1306 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1307 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1308 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1309 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1310 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1311 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1312 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1313 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1314
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001315deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1316 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001317 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001318
1319deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001320 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001321 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1322
1323deviceatlas-separator <char>
1324 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1325 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1326
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001327deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001328 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1329 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1330 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001331
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001332expose-experimental-directives
1333 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1334 the config file will be rejected.
1335
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001337 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1338 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001339 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1340 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1341 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1342 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1343 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001344
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001345fd-hard-limit <number>
1346 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1347 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1348 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1349 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1350 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1351 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1352 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1353 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1354 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1355 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1356 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1357 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1358
1359 global
1360 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1361 fd-hard-limit 50000
1362
1363 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001365gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001366 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001367 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1368 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001369 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001370 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001371 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001372
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001373grace <time>
1374 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1375
1376 Arguments :
1377 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1378 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1379 soft-stop operation.
1380
1381 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1382 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1383 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1384 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1385 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1386 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1387 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1388 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1389 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1390
1391 Example:
1392
1393 global
1394 grace 10s
1395
1396 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1397 frontend ext-check
1398 bind :9999
1399 monitor-uri /ext-check
1400 monitor fail if { stopping }
1401
1402 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1403 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1404 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1405 SIGUSR1 signal.
1406
1407 Example:
1408
1409 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1410 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1411 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1412 frontend ext-check
1413 bind :9999
1414 monitor-uri /ext-check
1415 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1416
1417 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1418
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001419group <group name>
1420 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1421 See also "gid" and "user".
1422
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001423hard-stop-after <time>
1424 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1425
1426 Arguments :
1427 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1428 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1429 SIGUSR1 signal.
1430
1431 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1432 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1433 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1434
1435 Example:
1436 global
1437 hard-stop-after 30s
1438
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001439 See also: grace
1440
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001441h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1442 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1443 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1444 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1445 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001446 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001447 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1448 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1449 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1450 specified in a proxy.
1451
1452 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1453 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1454 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1455 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1456 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1457 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1458 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1459
1460 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1461 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1462 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1463 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1464 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1465
1466 Example:
1467 global
1468 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1469
1470 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1471 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1472
1473h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1474 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1475 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1476 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1477 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1478 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1479 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1480 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1481 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1482
1483 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1484 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1485 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1486
1487 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1488 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1489
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001490httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1491 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1492 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1493 server line.
1494
1495 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1496 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1497 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1498
1499 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1500 configuration error if it fails.
1501
1502httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1503 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1504 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1505
1506 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1507 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1508
1509 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1510 configuration error if it fails.
1511
1512httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1513 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1514 to resolve.
1515
1516 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1517 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1518
1519 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1520 configuration error if it fails to load.
1521
1522httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1523 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1524 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1525 option is "ipv6".
1526
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001527insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001528 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001529 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1530 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1531 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1532 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1533 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1534 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1535 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001536 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001537 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1538 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1539 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1540 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1541 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1542 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1543 disable it.
1544
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001545insecure-setuid-wanted
1546 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1547 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1548 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1549 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001550 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001551 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001552 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001553 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1554 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001555 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001556 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1557 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1558 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1559 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1560
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001561issuers-chain-path <dir>
1562 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1563 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1564 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001565 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001566 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1567 "issuers-chain-path".
1568 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1569 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1570 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1571 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1572 will share the chain in memory.
1573
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001574h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1575 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1576 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1577 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1578 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1579 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1580 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1581 the keyword with "no'.
1582
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001583localpeer <name>
1584 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1585 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1586 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1587 the configuration parsing.
1588
1589 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1590 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1591
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001592log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001593 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001594 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001596 configured with "log global".
1597
1598 <address> can be one of:
1599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001600 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001601 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1602 port).
1603
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001604 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1605 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1606 port).
1607
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001608 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001609 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1610 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001611 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001612
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001613 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1614 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1615 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1616 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1617 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1618 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1619 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1620 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1621 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1622 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001623 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001624 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1625 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1626 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001627 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1628 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001629
1630 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1631 "fd@2", see above.
1632
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001633 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1634 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1635 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1636 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1637 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1638
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1640 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001641
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001642 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1643 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1644 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1645 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1646 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1647 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1648 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1649 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1650 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1651 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001652 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1653 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001654
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001655 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1656 one of the following :
1657
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001658 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1659 field is stripped. This is the default.
1660 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1661 rfc3164.
1662
1663 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001664 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1665
1666 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1667 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1668
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001669 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1670 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1671 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1672 designed to be used with a local log server.
1673
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001674 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1675 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1676 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1677 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1678 logger consumes.
1679
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001680 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1681 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1682 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1683 used with a local log server.
1684
1685 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1686 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1687 designed to be used with a local log server.
1688
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001689 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1690 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1691 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1692 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1693
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001694 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1695 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1696 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1697 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1698 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1699
1700 <sample_size>
1701 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1702 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1703 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1704 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1705 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1706
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001707 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001709 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1710 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1711 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1712
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001713 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1714 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1715 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1716 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717
1718 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001719 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1720 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1721 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1722 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1723 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1724 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001726 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001728log-send-hostname [<string>]
1729 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1730 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1731 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1732 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1733 the logs.
1734
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001735log-tag <string>
1736 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1737 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1738 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001739 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001740
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001741lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001742 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1743 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1744 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1745 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1746 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1747 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001748 used multiple times.
1749
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001750lua-load-per-thread <file>
1751 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1752 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1753 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1754 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1755 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1756 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1757 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1758 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1759 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1760 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1761 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1762 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1763 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1764 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1765 times.
1766
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001767lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1768 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1769 variable.
1770 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1771 to "path".
1772
1773 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1774 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1775 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1776 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1777 will be checked earlier.
1778
1779 As an example by specifying the following path:
1780
1781 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1782 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1783
1784 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1785 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1786 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1787 paths if that does not exist either.
1788
1789 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1790 documentation.
1791
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001792master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001793 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1794 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1795 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001797 or daemon mode.
1798
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001799 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1800 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1801 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1802 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1803 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001804
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001805 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001806
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001807mworker-max-reloads <number>
1808 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001809 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001810 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1811 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1812 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1813
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001814nbthread <number>
1815 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001816 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1817 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1818 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1819 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1820 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1821 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1822 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001823
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001824numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001825 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1826 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1827 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1828 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1829 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1830 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1831 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1832 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1833 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1834 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001836pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001837 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1838 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1839 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1840 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001841
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001842pp2-never-send-local
1843 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1844 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1845 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1846 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1847 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1848 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1849 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1850 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1851 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1852 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1853 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1854
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001855presetenv <name> <value>
1856 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1857 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1858 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1859 and "unsetenv".
1860
1861resetenv [<name> ...]
1862 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1863 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1864 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1865 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1866 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1867 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1868 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1869 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1870
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001871stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001872 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1873 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1874 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001875
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001876server-state-base <directory>
1877 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001878 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1879 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001880
1881server-state-file <file>
1882 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1883 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1884 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1885 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1886 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1887 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1888 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1889 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001890 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1891 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001892
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001893set-var <var-name> <expr>
1894 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1895 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1896 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1897 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1898 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1899 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001900 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001901 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1902 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1903
1904 Example:
1905 global
1906 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1907 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1908 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1909
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001910set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1911 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1912 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1913 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1914 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1915 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1916 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1917 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1918 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1919 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1920 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1921
1922 Example:
1923 global
1924 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1925 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1926
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001927setenv <name> <value>
1928 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1929 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1930 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1931 and "unsetenv".
1932
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001933set-dumpable
1934 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001935 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1936 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1937 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1938 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1939 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1940 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1941 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1942 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1943 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1944 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1945 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1946 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1947 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1948 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1949 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001950 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001951 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001952
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001953ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1955 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001956 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001957 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001958 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1959 information and recommendations see e.g.
1960 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1961 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1962 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1963 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001964
1965ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1967 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1968 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1969 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1970 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001971 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1972 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1973 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001974 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001975
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001976ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1978 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1979 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1980 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1981 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1982
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001983ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1985 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1986 keyword to see available options.
1987
1988 Example:
1989 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001990 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001991
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001992ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1994 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001995 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001996 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001997 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1998 information and recommendations see e.g.
1999 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2000 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2001 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2002 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2003 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002004
2005ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2007 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2008 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2009 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2010 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002011 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2012 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2013 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2014 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002015
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002016ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2017 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2018 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2019 keyword to see available options.
2020
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002021ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2023 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2024 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002025 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002026 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002027 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002028 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2029 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2030 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2031 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002032 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2033 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2034 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2035
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002036ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2037 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2038 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002039 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002040 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002041 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2042
2043 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002044
2045 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2046 and won't try to remove them.
2047
2048 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2049
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002050ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002051 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002052 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2053 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2054 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002055
2056 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2057 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2058 optimize the startup time.
2059
2060 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2061 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2062 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2063
2064 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002065 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002066
2067 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002068 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2069 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002070
2071 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2072 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2073 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2074 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2075 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002076 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002077
2078 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002079 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002080 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2081 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2082 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2083 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2084 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002085 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002086
2087 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2088
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002089 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002090 a cert bundle.
2091
2092 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2093 separately in several "crt".
2094
2095 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2096 since files are loading separately.
2097
2098 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2099 required to commit them.
2100
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002101 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002102 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002103
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002104 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2105 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2106 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002107
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002108 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2109 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2110 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002111
2112 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002113 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2114 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002115
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002116 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2117 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2118
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002119 The default behavior is "all".
2120
2121 Example:
2122 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2123 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2124 ssl-load-extra-files none
2125
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002126 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2127 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002128
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002129ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2130 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2131 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2132 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2133
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002134ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002135 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002136 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2137 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2138 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2139 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2140 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2141 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002142 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002143
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002144stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2145 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2146 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2147 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002148 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002149 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002150
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002151 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2152 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2153 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002154
2155stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2156 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2157 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002158 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002159
2160stats maxconn <connections>
2161 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2162 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2163
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002164thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2165 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2166 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2167 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2168 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2169 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2170 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2171 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2172 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2173 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2174
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002175thread-groups <number>
2176 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2177 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2178 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2179
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002181 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2183 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2184 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2185
2186ulimit-n <number>
2187 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2188 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002189 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2190 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002191
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002192 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2193 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2194 manually specify this value.
2195
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002196 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2197
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002198unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2199 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2200
2201 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2202 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2203 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2204 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2205 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002206 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002207 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2208 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2209 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2210 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2211
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002212unsetenv [<name> ...]
2213 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2214 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2215 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2216 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2217 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2218 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2219 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221user <user name>
2222 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2223 See also "uid" and "group".
2224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002225node <name>
2226 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2227
2228 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2229 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2230 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2231 traffic.
2232
2233description <text>
2234 Add a text that describes the instance.
2235
2236 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2237 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2238 "<" and ">" characters.
2239
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100224051degrees-data-file <file path>
2241 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002242 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002243
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002244 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2246
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000224751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002248 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2249 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2250 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2251
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002252 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2254
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200225551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002256 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2257 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2258
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002259 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002260 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2261
226251degrees-cache-size <number>
2263 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2264 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2265 By default, this cache is disabled.
2266
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002267 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2269
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002270wurfl-data-file <file path>
2271 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2272 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2273
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002274 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002275 with USE_WURFL=1.
2276
2277wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2278 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2279 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2280 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2281
2282 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2283
2284 Valid WURFL properties are:
2285 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2286
2287 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2288 device.
2289
2290 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2291 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2292
2293 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2294 particular web request.
2295
2296 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2297 used Libwurfl API version.
2298
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002299 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2300 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2301
2302 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2303 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2304
2305 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2306
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002307 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002308 with USE_WURFL=1.
2309
2310wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2311 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2312 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2313
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002314 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002315 with USE_WURFL=1.
2316
2317wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2318 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2319 thus before the chroot.
2320
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002321 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002322 with USE_WURFL=1.
2323
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002324wurfl-cache-size <size>
2325 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2326 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002327 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002328 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002329
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002330 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002331 with USE_WURFL=1.
2332
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002333strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002334 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002335 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2336 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002337 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002338 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023403.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002341-----------------------
2342
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002343busy-polling
2344 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2345 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2346 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2347 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2348 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2349 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2350 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2351 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2352 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2353 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2354 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2355 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2356 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2357 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2358 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2359 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2360 "poll" pollers.
2361
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002362 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2363 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2364 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2365
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002366max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002367 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002368 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2369 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2370 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2371 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2372 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2373 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2374 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2375
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002376maxconn <number>
2377 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2378 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2379 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002380 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2381 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2382 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2383 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002384 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2385 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2386 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2387 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2388 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002389 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2390
2391 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002393maxconnrate <number>
2394 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2395 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2396 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2397 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2398 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2399 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2400 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2401 fairness.
2402
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002403maxcomprate <number>
2404 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002406 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2407 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2408 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002409 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002410 default value.
2411
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002412maxcompcpuusage <number>
2413 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2414 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2415 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002416 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2417 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2418 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2419 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002420
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002421maxpipes <number>
2422 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2423 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2424 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2425 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2426 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2427 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2428
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002429maxsessrate <number>
2430 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2431 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2432 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2433 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2434 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2435 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2436 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2437 fairness.
2438
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002439maxsslconn <number>
2440 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2441 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2442 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2443 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2444 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2445 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2446 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002447 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2448 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2449 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2450 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002451 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002452 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2453 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002454
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002455maxsslrate <number>
2456 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2457 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2458 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2459 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2460 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2461 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2462 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2463 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2464 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2465 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2466
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002467maxzlibmem <number>
2468 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2469 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2470 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002471 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2472 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2473 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2474
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002475no-memory-trimming
2476 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2477 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2478 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2479 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2480 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2481 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2482 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2483 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2484 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2485 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2486 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2487 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2488 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2489 not suffer from such a problem.
2490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002491noepoll
2492 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2493 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002494 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002495
2496nokqueue
2497 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2498 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2499 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2500
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002501noevports
2502 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2503 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2504 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2505 also "nopoll".
2506
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002507nopoll
2508 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2509 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002511 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2512 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002513
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002514nosplice
2515 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002516 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002517 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002518 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002519 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2520 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2521 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2522 "option splice-response".
2523
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002524nogetaddrinfo
2525 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2526 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2527
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002528noreuseport
2529 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2530 command line argument "-dR".
2531
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002532profiling.memory { on | off }
2533 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2534 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2535 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2536 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2537 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2538 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2539 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2540 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2541 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2542
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002543profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2544 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2545 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2546 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2547 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002548 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002549 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2550 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2551 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2552 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2553
2554 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2555 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2556 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2557 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2558 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002559 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2560 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2561 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2562 CLI.
2563
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002564spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002565 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2566 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2567 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2568 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2569 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2570 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002571
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002573 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002574 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002575 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002576 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002577 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2578 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2579 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002580 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2581 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002582 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2583 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2584 openssl configuration file uses:
2585 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2586
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002587ssl-mode-async
2588 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002589 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002590 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2591 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002592 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002593 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002594 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002595
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002596tune.buffers.limit <number>
2597 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2598 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2599 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2600 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2601 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002602 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002603 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2604 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2605 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2606 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2607 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2608 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2609 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2610 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002611 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002612
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002613tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2614 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2615 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2616 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002617 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002618
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002619tune.bufsize <number>
2620 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2621 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2622 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2623 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2624 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2625 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2626 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002627 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2628 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002629 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002630 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002631 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002632 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2633 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002634
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002635tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2636 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2637 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2638 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2639 this value. The default value is 1.
2640
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002641tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002642 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2643 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2644 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2645 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002646
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002647tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2648 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2649 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2650 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2651 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2652 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2653
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002654tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2655 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2656 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2657 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2658 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2659 change it.
2660
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002661tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2662 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002663 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002665 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2666 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2667 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2668 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2669 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2670
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002671tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2672 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2673 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2674 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2675 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2676 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002677 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002678 recommended not to change this value.
2679
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002680tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002681 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002682 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002683 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002684 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2685 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2686 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2687 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2688
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002689tune.http.cookielen <number>
2690 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2691 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2692 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2693 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2694 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2695 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2696 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2697 to change this value.
2698
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002699tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002700 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2701 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002702 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002703 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002704 configuration directives too.
2705 The default value is 1024.
2706
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002707tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2708 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2709 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2710 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2711 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2712 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2713 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002714 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2715 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2716 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002717
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002718tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2719 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2720 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2721 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2722 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2723 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2724 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002725 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2726 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2727 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2728 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2729 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002730
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002731tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002732 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002733 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2734 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2735 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2736 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002737 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002738 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002739 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002740 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2741
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002742tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2744 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2745 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2746 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2747 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2748 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2749 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2750 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2751 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2752
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002753tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2754 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002755 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002756 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2757 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002758 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002759 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2760 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2761
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002762tune.lua.maxmem
2763 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2764 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2765 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2766 memory.
2767
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002768tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2769 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002770 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2771 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002772 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002773
2774tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2775 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2776 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2777 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2778 check servers.
2779
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002780tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2781 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2782 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2783 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002784 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002785
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002786tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002787 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2788 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002789 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2790 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2791 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2792 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2793 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2794 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2795 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2796 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2797 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002798
2799tune.maxpollevents <number>
2800 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2801 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2802 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2803 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2804 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2805
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002806tune.maxrewrite <number>
2807 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2808 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2809 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2810 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2811 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2812 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2813 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2814 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2815 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2816 bufsize.
2817
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002818tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2819 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2820 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2821 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2822 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2823 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2824 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2825 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2826 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2827 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002828 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2829 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002830 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2831 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2832 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2833 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2834 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2835 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2836 setting this parameter to 0.
2837
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002838tune.pipesize <number>
2839 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2840 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2841 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2842 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2843 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2844 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2845
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002846tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2847 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002848 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002849 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2850 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2851 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2852 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002853 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002854
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002855tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002857 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002858 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2859 default is 20.
2860
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002861tune.quic.conn-buf-limit <number>
2862 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2863 change without deprecation in the future.
2864
2865 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
2866 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
2867 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
2868 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
2869 time-trip.
2870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002890 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2891 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2892 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2893 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2894 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2895 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2896 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002897
2898tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2899 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002900 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002901 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2902 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2903 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2904 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2905 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2906 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2907 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002908
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002909tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2910tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2911 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2912 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2913 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002914 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002915 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002916 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2917 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2918 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2919 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002921
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002922tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002923 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002924 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2925 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2926 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2927 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2928 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2929 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2930 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2931 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2932 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002933 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2934 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002935
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002936tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002937 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002938 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2939 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2940 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2941 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2942 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2943
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02002944tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
2945 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
2946 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
2947 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
2948 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
2949
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002950tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2951 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2952 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2953 performances. This is disabled by default.
2954
2955 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2956 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2957
2958 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2959
2960 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2961
2962 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2963
2964 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2965 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2966 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2967
2968 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2969 converted.
2970
2971 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2972 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2973 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2974 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2975 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2976 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2977 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002978 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2979 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002980
2981 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2982
2983 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2984 only need this line:
2985
2986 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2987
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002988tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2989 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002990 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002991 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2992 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2993 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2994 being used for too long.
2995
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002996tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02002997 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
2998 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
2999 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3000 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3001 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3002 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3003 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3004 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3005 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3006 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3007 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3008 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3009 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003010
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003011tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3012 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3013 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3014 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3015 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02003016 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3017 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3018 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3019 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3020 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3021 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3022 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3023 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003024
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003025tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3026 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3027 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3028 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3029 1000 entries.
3030
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02003031tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3032tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02003033 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3034 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3035 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3036 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01003037
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003038tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003039tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003040tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3041tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3042tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003043 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3044 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3045 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3046 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3047 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3048 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3049 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3050 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003051
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003052 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3053 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3054 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3055 all available space is consumed.
3056 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3057 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3058 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003059
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003060tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3061 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003062 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003063 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003064 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003065 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3066
3067tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3068 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3069 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003070 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3071 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030733.3. Debugging
3074--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003075
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003076quiet
3077 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3078 line argument "-q".
3079
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003080zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003081 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003082 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3083 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3084 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3085 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3086 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3087
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010030893.4. Userlists
3090--------------
3091It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3092http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3093it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3094
3095userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003096 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003097 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3098
3099group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003100 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003101 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3102 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003104user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3105 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003106 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3107 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003108 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3109 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3110 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3111 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003112
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003113 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3114 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3115 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3116 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3117 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3118 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3119 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003120 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003121 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003122
3123 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003124 userlist L1
3125 group G1 users tiger,scott
3126 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003128 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3129 user scott insecure-password elgato
3130 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003132 userlist L2
3133 group G1
3134 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003135
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003136 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3137 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3138 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003139
3140 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003141
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003142
31433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003144----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003145It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003146several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003147instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003148values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3149type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3150values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3151active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3152switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3153present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3154watch it.
3155
3156Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3157known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3158the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3159process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3160during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3161tables.
3162
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003163Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3164that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3165each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003166
3167peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003168 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003169 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3170
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003171bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3172 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3173 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3174
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003175disabled
3176 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3177 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3178 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3179
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003180default-bind [param*]
3181 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3182
3183default-server [param*]
3184 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3185
3186 Arguments:
3187 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3188 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3189 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3190 details.
3191
3192
3193 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3194
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003195enabled
3196 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3197 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003198
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003199log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003200 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3201 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3202 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3203 more details.
3204
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003205peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003206 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3207 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003208 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003209 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003210 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3211 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3212 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003213
3214 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3215 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3216
3217 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003218 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3219 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3220 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003221
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003222 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3223 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003224
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003225 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3226 "server" keyword explanation below).
3227
3228server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003229 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003230 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3231 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +02003232 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003233 of this "peers" section).
3234 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3235
3236
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003237 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003238 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003239 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003240 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3241 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3242 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003243
3244 backend mybackend
3245 mode tcp
3246 balance roundrobin
3247 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3248 stick on src
3249
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003252
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003253 Example:
3254 peers mypeers
3255 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3256 default-server ssl verify none
3257 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3258 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003259
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003260
3261table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3262 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3263
3264 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3265 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003266 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003267 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3268 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3269 "stick-table" keyword).
3270
3271 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3272 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3273 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3274 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3275 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3276 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3277 of the stick-table name as follows:
3278
3279 peers mypeers
3280 peer A ...
3281 peer B ...
3282 table t1 ...
3283
3284 frontend fe1
3285 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3286
3287 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3288 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3289
3290 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3291 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3292 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3293 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3294 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3295 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3296 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3297
3298 peers mypeers
3299 peer A ...
3300 peer B ...
3301 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3302
3303 backend t1
3304 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3305
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003306 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003307 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3308 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3309
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090033103.6. Mailers
3311------------
3312It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3313If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3314in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3315
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003316mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003317 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3318 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3319
3320mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3321 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3322
3323 Example:
3324 mailers mymailers
3325 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3326 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3327
3328 backend mybackend
3329 mode tcp
3330 balance roundrobin
3331
3332 email-alert mailers mymailers
3333 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3334 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3335
3336 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3337 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3338
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003339timeout mail <time>
3340 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3341 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3342 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3343 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3344
3345 Example:
3346 mailers mymailers
3347 timeout mail 20s
3348 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003349
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020033503.7. Programs
3351-------------
3352In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3353master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3354managed the same way as the workers.
3355
3356During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3357sequence as a worker:
3358
3359 - the master is re-executed
3360 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3361 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3362 instance of the program
3363
3364During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3365
3366program <name>
3367 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3368 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3369 the management guide).
3370
3371command <command> [arguments*]
3372 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3373 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3374 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3375 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3376
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003377user <user name>
3378 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3379 See also "group".
3380
3381group <group name>
3382 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3383 See also "user".
3384
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003385option start-on-reload
3386no option start-on-reload
3387 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3388 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3389 program section.
3390
3391
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010033923.8. HTTP-errors
3393----------------
3394
3395It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3396imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3397several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3398
3399http-errors <name>
3400 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3401 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3402
3403errorfile <code> <file>
3404 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3405
3406 Arguments :
3407 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003408 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003409 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003410
3411 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3412 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3413 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3414 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3415 before any chroot is performed.
3416
3417 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3418
3419 Example:
3420 http-errors website-1
3421 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3422 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3423 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3424
3425 http-errors website-2
3426 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3427 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3428 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3429
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020034303.9. Rings
3431----------
3432
3433It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3434servers or traces.
3435
3436ring <ringname>
3437 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3438
3439description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003440 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003441 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3442
3443format <format>
3444 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3445
3446 Arguments:
3447 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3448 one of the following :
3449
3450 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3451 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3452 designed to be used with a local log server.
3453
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003454 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3455 field is stripped. This is the default.
3456 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3457 rfc3164.
3458
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003459 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3460 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3461 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3462 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3463 is the default.
3464
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003465 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003466 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3467
3468 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3469 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3470
3471 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3472 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3473 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3474 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3475 logger consumes.
3476
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003477 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3478 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3479 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3480 with a local log server.
3481
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003482 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3483 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3484 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3485 used with a local log server.
3486
3487maxlen <length>
3488 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3489 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3490 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3491
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003492server <name> <address> [param*]
3493 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3494 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3495 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3496 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3497 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3498 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3499 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3500 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3501 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003502 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3503 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003504
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003505size <size>
3506 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3507 set to BUFSIZE.
3508
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003509timeout connect <timeout>
3510 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3511
3512 Arguments :
3513 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3514 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3515 as explained at the top of this document.
3516
3517timeout server <timeout>
3518 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3519
3520 Arguments :
3521 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3522 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3523 as explained at the top of this document.
3524
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003525 Example:
3526 global
3527 log ring@myring local7
3528
3529 ring myring
3530 description "My local buffer"
3531 format rfc3164
3532 maxlen 1200
3533 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003534 timeout connect 5s
3535 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003536 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003537
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020035383.10. Log forwarding
3539-------------------
3540
3541It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003543
3544log-forward <name>
3545 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3546
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003547backlog <conns>
3548 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3549 on connections accept.
3550
3551bind <addr> [param*]
3552 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003553 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3554 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3555 syslog protocol over TCP.
3556 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003557 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3558
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003559dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003560 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3561 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3562 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3563 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003564 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003565
3566log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003567log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003568 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3569 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3570 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003571 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003572 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3573 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3574 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003575 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003576
3577 Example:
3578 global
3579 log stderr format iso local7
3580
3581 ring myring
3582 description "My local buffer"
3583 format rfc5424
3584 maxlen 1200
3585 size 32764
3586 timeout connect 5s
3587 timeout server 10s
3588 # syslog tcp server
3589 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3590
3591 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003592 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3593 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003594 # all messages on stderr
3595 log global
3596 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3597 log ring@myring local0
3598 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3599 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3600 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3601 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3602 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003603
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003604maxconn <conns>
3605 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3606 10 is the default.
3607
3608timeout client <timeout>
3609 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003612----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003614Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003615 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3616 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3617 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3618 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003619
3620A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3621connections.
3622
3623A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3624to forward incoming connections.
3625
3626A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3627parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3628
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003629A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3630ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3631sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3632the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3633explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3634from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3635"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3636for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3637to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3638optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3639are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3640any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3641names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3642that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3643duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003644names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3645is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3646implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3647encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3648adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003649
3650Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3651settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3652of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3653profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3654timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3655
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3657'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3658case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3659
3660Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3661logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3662proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3663However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3664name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3665
3666Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3667and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003668bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3670modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3671arbitrary criteria.
3672
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003673In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3674a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003675the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003676
3677 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3678 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3679 between responses and new requests.
3680
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003681 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3682 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3683 client-facing connection remains open.
3684
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003685 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3686 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003687
3688The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3689frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3690following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003691weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003692
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003693 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003695 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3696 ----+-----+-----+----
3697 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3698 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003699 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3700 ----+-----+-----+----
3701 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003702
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003703It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003704only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3705within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003706as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003707content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003708and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3709possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003710
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003711There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003712first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003713processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003714second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003715protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3716is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3717new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003718to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003719process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3720already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3721HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3722evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3723one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3724
3725There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3726performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3727tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3728preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3729analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3730HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3731header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3732mitigate this drawback.
3733
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003734There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003735method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3736set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3737in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3738is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3739to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3740above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3741to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3742"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3743frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3744frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3745as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3746upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3747on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3748the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3749upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3750frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3751remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3754--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003756The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3757limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3758they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3759limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003760marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003761option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003762and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3763with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003764specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3765sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3766anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003768
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003769 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3770------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003771acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003772backlog X X X -
3773balance X - X X
3774bind - X X -
3775bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003776capture cookie - X X -
3777capture request header - X X -
3778capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003779clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3780clitcpka-idle X X X -
3781clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003782compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003783cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003784declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003785default-server X - X X
3786default_backend X X X -
3787description - X X X
3788disabled X X X X
3789dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003790email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003791email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003792email-alert mailers X X X X
3793email-alert myhostname X X X X
3794email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003795enabled X X X X
3796errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003797errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003798errorloc X X X X
3799errorloc302 X X X X
3800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3801errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003802error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003803force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003804filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003805fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003806hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003807http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003808http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003809http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003810http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003811http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003812http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003813http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003814http-check set-var X - X X
3815http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003816http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003817http-request X (!) X X X
3818http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003819http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003820http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003821id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003822ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003823load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003824log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003825log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003826log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003827log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003828max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003829maxconn X X X -
3830mode X X X X
3831monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003832monitor-uri X X X -
3833option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3834option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3835option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3836option allbackups (*) X - X X
3837option checkcache (*) X - X X
3838option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3839option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003840option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003841option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3842option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003843-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3844option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003845option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3846option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003847option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003848option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003849option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003850option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003851option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003852option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3853option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3854option httpchk X - X X
3855option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003856option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003857option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003858option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003859option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003860option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003861option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3862option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3863option logasap (*) X X X -
3864option mysql-check X - X X
3865option nolinger (*) X X X X
3866option originalto X X X X
3867option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003868option pgsql-check X - X X
3869option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003870option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003871option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003872option smtpchk X - X X
3873option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3874option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3875option splice-request (*) X X X X
3876option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003877option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003878option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3879option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3880-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003881option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003882option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3883option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3884option tcpka X X X X
3885option tcplog X X X X
3886option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003887option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003888external-check command X - X X
3889external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003890persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3891rate-limit sessions X X X -
3892redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003893-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003894retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003895retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003896server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003897server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003898server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003899source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003900srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3901srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3902srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003903stats admin - X X X
3904stats auth X X X X
3905stats enable X X X X
3906stats hide-version X X X X
3907stats http-request - X X X
3908stats realm X X X X
3909stats refresh X X X X
3910stats scope X X X X
3911stats show-desc X X X X
3912stats show-legends X X X X
3913stats show-node X X X X
3914stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003915-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3916stick match - - X X
3917stick on - - X X
3918stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003919stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003920stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003921tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003922tcp-check connect X - X X
3923tcp-check expect X - X X
3924tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003925tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003926tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003927tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003928tcp-check set-var X - X X
3929tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003930tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3931tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3932tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3933tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3934tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3935tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003936timeout check X - X X
3937timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003938timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003939timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003940timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3941timeout http-request X X X X
3942timeout queue X - X X
3943timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003944timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003945timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003946timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003947transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003948unique-id-format X X X -
3949unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003950use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003951use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003952use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003953------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3954 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3958---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959
3960This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3961
3962
3963acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3964 Declare or complete an access list.
3965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003966 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3967
3968 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3969 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3970 using it.
3971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003972 Example:
3973 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3974 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3975 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003977 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003978
3979
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003980backlog <conns>
3981 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | yes | yes | no
3984 Arguments :
3985 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3986 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003987 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003988
3989 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3990 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3991 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3992 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3993 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3994 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3995 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3996 backlog parameter.
3997
3998 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3999 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4000 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4001
4002 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4003
4004
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004006balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004007 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | no | yes | yes
4010 Arguments :
4011 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4012 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4013 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4014 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4015
4016 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4017 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4018 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4019 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004020 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004021 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004022 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4023 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4024 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4025 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4026 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4027 it, so that you don't worry.
4028
4029 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4030 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4031 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4032 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4033 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4034 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4035 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4036 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004038 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4039 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4040 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4041 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4042 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4043 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4044 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004045 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4046 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4047 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004048
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004049 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004050 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004051 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4052 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004053 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004054 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4055 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4056 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4057 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4058 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004059 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4060 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4061 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4062 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4063 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4064 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004065
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004066 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4067 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4068 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4069 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4070 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4071 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4072 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4073 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4074 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4075 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4076 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4077 changed using "hash-type".
4078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4080 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4081 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4082 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4083 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4084 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4085 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4086 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004087 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004088 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004089 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4090 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004091 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004092
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004093 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4094 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4095 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4096 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4097 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4098 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4099 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4100 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4101 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4102 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4103 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4104 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004105
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004106 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004107 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4108 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4109 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4110 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4111 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4112 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4113 URIs start with a leading "/".
4114
4115 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4116 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4117 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4118 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4119
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004120 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4121 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4122 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004123 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4124 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004127 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4128
4129 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004130 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4131 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004132 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4133 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4134 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4135 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004136 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004137 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4138 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004139
4140 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4141 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4142 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4143 server will receive the request.
4144
4145 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4146 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4147 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4148 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4149 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004150 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4151 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004152 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4153 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004155 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4156 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4157 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4158 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4159 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004161 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004162 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4163 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4164 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4165
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004166 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4167 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004168 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4169 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004170
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004171 random
4172 random(<draws>)
4173 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004174 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4175 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4176 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4177 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004178 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4179 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4180 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4181 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4182 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4183 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4184 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4185 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4186 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4187 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4188 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4189 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4190 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4191 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4192 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4193 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4194 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4195 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4196 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4197 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004198
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004199 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004200 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004201 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4202 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004203 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004204 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4205 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4206 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004207 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004208 used instead.
4209
4210 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4211 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4212 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004213 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004214
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004215 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4216 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004217 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4218 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004220 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004221 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4222 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004223
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004224 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4225 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4226 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004227
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004228 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004229 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004230 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4231 NTLM relies on.
4232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004233 Examples :
4234 balance roundrobin
4235 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004236 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004237 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4238 balance hdr(host)
4239 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004240 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4241 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4242 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004243
4244 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4245 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004247 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004248 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4249 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4250 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004251 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004252
4253 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4254 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4255 defaults to 16 kB.
4256
4257 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4258 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4259
4260 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4261 Round Robin.
4262
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004263 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004264 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4265 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4266 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4267
4268 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4269
4270 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004271 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004272 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4273 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4274 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004275
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004276 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
4278
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004279bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4280bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004281 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004285 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4286 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4287 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4288 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004289 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004290 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4291 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4292 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4293 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4294 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4295 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004296 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004297 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4298 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004299 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004300 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4301 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004302 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004303 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4304 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004305 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004306 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004307 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4308 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4309 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004310 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4311 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4312 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4313 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004314 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4315 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4316 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004317
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004318 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4319 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004320 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4321 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4322 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004323 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4324 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4325 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4326 the range.
4327
4328 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4329 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4330 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4331 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4332 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4333 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4334 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004335 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004336 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004338 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004339 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004340 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4341 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4342 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4343 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4344 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4345 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004347 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4348 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4349 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4350 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004352 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4353 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4354 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4355 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4356 in a frontend.
4357
4358 Example :
4359 listen http_proxy
4360 bind :80,:443
4361 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004362 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004363
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004364 listen http_https_proxy
4365 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004366 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004367
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004368 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4369 bind ipv6@:80
4370 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4371 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4372
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004373 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004374 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004375
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004376 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4377 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4378 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4379 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4380 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4381
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004382 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004383 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004384
4385
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004386bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004389
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004390 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4391 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4392 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4393 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4394 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4395 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004396
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004397 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004398
4399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004400capture cookie <name> len <length>
4401 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4403 no | yes | yes | no
4404 Arguments :
4405 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4406 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4407 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4408 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004409 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004410
4411 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4412 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4413 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4414 right if it exceeds <length>.
4415
4416 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4417 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4418 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4419 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4420
4421 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4422 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4423 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4424
4425 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4426 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4427 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004428 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4429 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4430 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004431
4432 Example:
4433 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4434
4435 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004436 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004437
4438
4439capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004440 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 no | yes | yes | no
4443 Arguments :
4444 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004445 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004446 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4447 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4448 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4449
4450 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4451 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4452 it exceeds <length>.
4453
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004454 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004455 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4456 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004457 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4458 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4459 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4460 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004461 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004462 environments to find where the request came from.
4463
4464 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4465 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4466 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4467 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004469 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4470 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4471 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4472 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4473 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004474
4475 Example:
4476 capture request header Host len 15
4477 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004478 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004480 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004481 about logging.
4482
4483
4484capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004485 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 no | yes | yes | no
4488 Arguments :
4489 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004490 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4492 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4493 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4494
4495 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4496 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4497 it exceeds <length>.
4498
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004499 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004500 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4501 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4502 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004503 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4504 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4505 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4506 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004508 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4509 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4510 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4511 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4512 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004513
4514 Example:
4515 capture response header Content-length len 9
4516 capture response header Location len 15
4517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004518 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519 about logging.
4520
4521
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004522clitcpka-cnt <count>
4523 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4524 the connection on the client side.
4525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | yes | yes | no
4527 Arguments :
4528 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4529
4530 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4531 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004532 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4533 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004534
4535 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4536
4537
4538clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4539 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4540 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4541 client side.
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 yes | yes | yes | no
4544 Arguments :
4545 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4546 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4547 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4548 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4549
4550 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4551 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004552 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4553 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004554
4555 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4556
4557
4558clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4559 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | yes | yes | no
4562 Arguments :
4563 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4564 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4565 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4566 document.
4567
4568 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4569 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004570 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4571 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004572
4573 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4574
4575
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004576compression algo <algorithm> ...
4577compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004578 Enable HTTP compression.
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 yes | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004582 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4583 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004584
4585 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004586 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4587 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4588 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004589
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004590 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004591 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004592
4593 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4594 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4595 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4596 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4597 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004598 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004599
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004600 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4601 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4602 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4603 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4604 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4605 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4606 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004607 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004608
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004609 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004610 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004611 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004612 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004613 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004614 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004615 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004616
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004617 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004618 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4619 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004620 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004621 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004622 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4623 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4624 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4625 "multipart"
4626 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4627 header
4628 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4629 and later
4630 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4631 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004632 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004633
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004634 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004635
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004636 Examples :
4637 compression algo gzip
4638 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004639
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004640 See also : "compression offload"
4641
4642compression offload
4643 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 no | yes | yes | yes
4646
4647 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4648 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4649 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4650 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4651 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4652 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4653 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4654 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4655 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4656 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4657 then be used for such scenarios.
4658
4659 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4660 option is ignored.
4661
4662 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004663
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004664cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004665 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4666 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004667 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 yes | no | yes | yes
4671 Arguments :
4672 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4673 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4674 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4675 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4676 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4677 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004678 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004679 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4680 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4681
4682 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004683 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004684 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4685 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4686 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4687 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004688 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4689 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004690 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004691 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4692 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004693
4694 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004695 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004696
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004697 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004698 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004699 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004700 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004701 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4702 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4703 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4704 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4705 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4706 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4707 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708
4709 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4710 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4711 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4712 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4713 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4714 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4715 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4716 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4717 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004718 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004719 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4720 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4721 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004722
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004723 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4724 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4725 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004726 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4727 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4728 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4729 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004730 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4731 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4732 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733
4734 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4735 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4736 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4737 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4738 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4739 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4740 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4741 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4742 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4743
4744 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4745 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4746 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4747 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4748 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4749 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4750 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4751 persistence cookie in the cache.
4752 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4753
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004754 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4755 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004756 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004757 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4758 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004759 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004760 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4761 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4762 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4763 they logout.
4764
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004765 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004766 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4767 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4768 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4769
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004770 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004771 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4772 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4773 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4774 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4775 this attribute.
4776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004777 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004778 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004779 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4780 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4781 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4782 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4783 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4784 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004785
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004786 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4787 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4788 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4789 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4790 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4791 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4792 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4793 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004795 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4796 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4797 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4798 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4799 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4800 the site.
4801
4802 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4803 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4804 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4805 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4806 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4807 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4808 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4809 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4810 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4811 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4812 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4813 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4814 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004815 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004816 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4817 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4818
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004819 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4820 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4821 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4822 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4823 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4824 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4825
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004826 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004827 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4828 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4829 repeated.
4830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004831 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4832 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4833 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4834 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004836 Examples :
4837 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4838 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4839 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004840 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004842 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004843
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004844
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004845declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4846 Declares a capture slot.
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 no | yes | yes | no
4849 Arguments:
4850 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4851
4852 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4853 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4854 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4855 for use in the response.
4856
4857 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004858 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004859 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4860
4861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004862default-server [param*]
4863 Change default options for a server in a backend
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 yes | no | yes | yes
4866 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004867 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4868 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4869 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4870 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004871
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004872 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004873 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4874
4875 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004876
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004878default_backend <backend>
4879 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4881 yes | yes | yes | no
4882 Arguments :
4883 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4884
4885 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4886 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4887 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4888 will catch all undetermined requests.
4889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004890 Example :
4891
4892 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4893 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4894 default_backend dynamic
4895
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004896 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004898
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004899description <string>
4900 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4902 no | yes | yes | yes
4903 Arguments : string
4904
4905 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4906 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4907 it describes.
4908 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4909
4910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004911disabled
4912 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments : none
4916
4917 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4918 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4919 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4920 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4921 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4922 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4923 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4924
4925 See also : "enabled"
4926
4927
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004928dispatch <address>:<port>
4929 Set a default server address
4930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004932 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004933
4934 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4935 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4936 during start-up.
4937
4938 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4939 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4940 possible with normal servers.
4941
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004942 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004943 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4944 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4945 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4946 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4947
4948 See also : "server"
4949
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004950
4951dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4952 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | no | yes | yes
4955 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4956
4957 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004958 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004959 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4960 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004961 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004962 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004964enabled
4965 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4967 yes | yes | yes | yes
4968 Arguments : none
4969
4970 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4971 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4972
4973 See also : "disabled"
4974
4975
4976errorfile <code> <file>
4977 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | yes | yes | yes
4980 Arguments :
4981 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004982 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004983 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004984
4985 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004986 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004987 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004988 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4989 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004990
4991 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4992 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4993 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4994
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004995 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4996
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004997 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4998 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4999 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5000 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5001 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5002 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5003 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5004 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5005 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005006
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005007 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5008 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5009 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005010 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005011 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5012
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005013 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005014
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005015 Example :
5016 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005017 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005018 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5019 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005021
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005022errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5023 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5024 section.
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027 Arguments :
5028 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5029
5030 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005031 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005032 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5033 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005034
5035 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5036 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5037 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5038 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5039 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005040 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005041 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5042
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005043 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5044 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005045
5046 Example :
5047 errorfiles generic
5048 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5049
5050
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005051errorloc <code> <url>
5052errorloc302 <code> <url>
5053 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | yes | yes | yes
5056 Arguments :
5057 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005058 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005059 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005060
5061 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5062 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5063 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5064 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005065 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005066
5067 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5068 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5069 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5070
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005071 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5072
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005073 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5074 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5075 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5076 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005077 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005078 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5079 request.
5080
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005081 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005082
5083
5084errorloc303 <code> <url>
5085 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5087 yes | yes | yes | yes
5088 Arguments :
5089 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005090 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005091 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005092
5093 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5094 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5095 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5096 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005097 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005098
5099 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5100 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5101 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5102
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005103 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5104
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005105 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5106 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5107 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5108 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005109 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005110
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005111 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005112
5113
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005114email-alert from <emailaddr>
5115 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005116 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | yes | yes | yes
5119
5120 Arguments :
5121
5122 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5123
5124 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5125 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5126
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005127 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005128 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5129 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005130
5131
5132email-alert level <level>
5133 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5134 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | yes | yes | yes
5137
5138 Arguments :
5139
5140 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5141 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5142 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5143
5144 By default level is alert
5145
5146 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5147 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5148 for the proxy.
5149
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005150 Alerts are sent when :
5151
5152 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5153 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5154 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5155 is notice or lower
5156 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5157 and a health check status update occurs
5158
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005159 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5160 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005161 section 3.6 about mailers.
5162
5163
5164email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5165 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5167 yes | yes | yes | yes
5168
5169 Arguments :
5170
5171 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5172
5173 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5174 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5175
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005176 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5177 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005178
5179
5180email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5181 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5182 mailers.
5183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | yes | yes | yes
5185
5186 Arguments :
5187
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005188 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005189
5190 By default the systems hostname is used.
5191
5192 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5193 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5194 for the proxy.
5195
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005196 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5197 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005198
5199
5200email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005201 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005202 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 yes | yes | yes | yes
5205
5206 Arguments :
5207
5208 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5209
5210 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5211 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5212
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005213 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005214 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5215
5216
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005217error-log-format <string>
5218 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | yes | yes | no
5221
5222 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5223 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5224 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5225 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005226 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5227
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005228 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5229 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5230 string in depth.
5231
5232 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5233 directives.
5234
5235
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005236force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5237 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005239 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005240
5241 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5242 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5243 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5244 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5245 marked down for maintenance operations.
5246
5247 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5248 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5249 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5250 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5251 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5252 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5253 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5254 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5255 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5256
5257 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5258 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5259 is used.
5260
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005261 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005262 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005263
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005264
5265filter <name> [param*]
5266 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 no | yes | yes | yes
5269 Arguments :
5270 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5271 referenced in section 9.
5272
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005273 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005274 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005275 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5276 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005277
5278 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5279 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5280
5281 Example:
5282 listen
5283 bind *:80
5284
5285 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5286 filter compression
5287 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5288
5289 compression algo gzip
5290 compression offload
5291
5292 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5293
5294 See also : section 9.
5295
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005297fullconn <conns>
5298 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5300 yes | no | yes | yes
5301 Arguments :
5302 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5303 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5304
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005305 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005306 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005307 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005308 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5309 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5310 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5311 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5312 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005313 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005314
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005315 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005316 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005317 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5318 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5319 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005321 Example :
5322 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5323 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5324 # connections.
5325 backend dynamic
5326 fullconn 10000
5327 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5328 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5329
5330 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5331
5332
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005333hash-balance-factor <factor>
5334 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | no | yes
5337 Arguments :
5338 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5339 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005340 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005341
5342 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5343 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5344 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5345 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5346 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5347 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5348 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5349
5350 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5351 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5352 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5353 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5354 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5355
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005356 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5357 consistent hashing mechanism.
5358
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005359 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5360
5361
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005362hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005363 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5365 yes | no | yes | yes
5366 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005367 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5368 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005369
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005370 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5371 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5372 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5373 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5374 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5375 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5376 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5377 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5378 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5379 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005380
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005381 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5382 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5383 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5384 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5385 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5386 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5387 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5388 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5389 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5390 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5391 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5392 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5393 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005394 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5395 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005396
5397 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5398
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005399 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005400 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5401 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5402 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005403 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5404 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5405 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005406
5407 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5408 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005409 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5410 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5411 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5412 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005414 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005415 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5416 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5417 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5418 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5419 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5420 parameter.
5421
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005422 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5423 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5424 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5425 used on strings.
5426
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005427 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5428
5429 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5430 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5431 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5432 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5433 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5434 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5435 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5436 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5437 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5438 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5439 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5440 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005441
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005442 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5443 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5444 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005445
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005446 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005447
5448
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005449http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5450 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5451 ones).
5452
5453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005454 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005455
5456 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5457 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5458 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5459 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5460 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5461 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5462
5463 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5464 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5465 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005467 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5468 supported:
5469 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5470 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005471 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005472 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5473 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5474 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5475 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5476 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005477 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5478 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005479 - strict-mode { on | off }
5480 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5481
5482 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005483
5484 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5485 instance.
5486
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005487 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5488 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5489 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5490 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5491 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5492 a defaults section defining such rules.
5493
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005494 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5495 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5496 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5497
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005498 Example:
5499 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5500 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5501 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5502
5503http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5504
5505 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005506 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5507 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005508
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005509http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5510
5511 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5512 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5513 complete description.
5514
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005515http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5516
5517 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005518 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005519
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005520http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005521
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005522 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5523 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005524
5525http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5526 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5527
5528 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5529
5530 Example:
5531 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5532
5533 # applied to:
5534 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5535
5536 # outputs:
5537 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5538
5539 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5540
5541http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5543
5544 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5545
5546 Example:
5547 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5548
5549 # applied to:
5550 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5551
5552 # outputs:
5553 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5554
5555http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5556
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005557 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5558 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5559 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5560 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005561
5562http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5564
5565 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005566 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005567 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005568
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005569http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5570http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005571
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005572 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5573 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5574 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005575
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005576http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005577
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005578 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5579 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005580
5581http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5582
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005583 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5584 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005585
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005586
5587http-check comment <string>
5588 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5589 it fails.
5590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5591 yes | no | yes | yes
5592
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005593 Arguments :
5594 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5595 rule fails.
5596
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005597 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5598 user-friendly error reporting.
5599
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005600 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005601 "http-check expect".
5602
5603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005604http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5605 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005606 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005607 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5609 yes | no | yes | yes
5610
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005611 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005612 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5613
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005614 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005615 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005616
5617 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5618 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5619 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5620 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5621
5622 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5623
5624 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5625
5626 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5627
5628 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5629
5630 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5631
5632 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5633 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5634 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5635 is used.
5636
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005637 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5638 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5639 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5640 haproxy -vv.
5641
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005642 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5643
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005644 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5645 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5646 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5647 different ports or with different servers.
5648
5649 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5650 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5651 the port with a "http-check connect".
5652
5653 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5654 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5655 do.
5656
5657 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5658 unset-var or comment rules.
5659
5660 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005661 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5662 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5663 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5664 option httpchk
5665
5666 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005667 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005668 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005669 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005670 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005671 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672
5673 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5674
5675 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005676
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005678http-check disable-on-404
5679 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005681 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005682 Arguments : none
5683
5684 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5685 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5686 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5687 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5688 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5689 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5690 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5691 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005692 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5693 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005694 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5695 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5696 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005697
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005698 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699
5700
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005701http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005702 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5703 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5704 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005705 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005707 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005709 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005710 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5711
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5713 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5714 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5715 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5716 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5717 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5718 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5719 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5720 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5721 result is always conclusive.
5722
5723 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5724 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5725 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005726 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5727 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005728 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5729 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005730 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5731 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5732 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733
5734 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5735 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005736 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5737 supported :
5738 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5739 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005740 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5741 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5742 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5743 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5744 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005745
5746 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5747 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005748 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5749 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5750 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5751 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005752 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5753
5754 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5755 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5756 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5757 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5758
5759 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5760 informational message reported in logs if an error
5761 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5762 log-format string.
5763
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005764 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005765 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5766 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005767 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5768 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5769 details on the supported keywords.
5770
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005771 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5772 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5773 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5774 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005775
5776 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5777 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5778 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5779 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5780 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5781
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005782 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5783 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5784 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5785 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5786 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5787 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5788 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005789
5790 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005791 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005792 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5793 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5794 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5795 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5796
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005797 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5798 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005799 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5800 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5801 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5802 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5803 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5804 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5805 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5806 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005807 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5808 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5809 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5810 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5811 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5812 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5813 insensitive on the header names.
5814
5815 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5816 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5817 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5818 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5819 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5820 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005821
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005822 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005823 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005824 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5825 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5826 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5827 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5828 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005829 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005830 trace).
5831
5832 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005834 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5835 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5836 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5837 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5838 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005839 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005840
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005841 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5843 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5844 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5845 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5846 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5847
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005848 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005849 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005850 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5851 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5852 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5853 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5854 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5855 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5856
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005857 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5858 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5859 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5860 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5861 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005862
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005863 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5864 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5865
5866 Examples :
5867 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005868 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005869
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005870 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5871 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5872
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005873 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005874 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005875
5876 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005877 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005878
5879 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005880 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005881
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005883 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005884
5885
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005886http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005887 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5888 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005889 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5890 health checks.
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | no | yes | yes
5893 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005894 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5895
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005896 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5897 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5898 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5899 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5900 to invent non-standard ones.
5901
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005902 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5903 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5904 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5905 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5906
5907 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5908 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5909 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5910 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005911
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005912 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005913 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005914 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005915 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5916 to add it.
5917
5918 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5919 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5920 to the log-format rules.
5921
5922 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5923 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5924 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005925
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005926 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5927 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5928 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5929 request.
5930
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005931 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5932 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5933 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005934 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5935 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5936 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5937 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005938 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005939
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005940 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005941 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5942 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005943
5944 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5945 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5946 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5947 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5948 configured request authority.
5949
5950 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5951 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005953 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005954
5955
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005956http-check send-state
5957 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | no | yes | yes
5960 Arguments : none
5961
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005962 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005963 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005964 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5965 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5966 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005967
5968 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5969 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5970 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5971 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5972 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005973 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5974 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5975 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5976
5977 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5978 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5979 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5980
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005981 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5982 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5983 checked in multiple backends.
5984
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005985 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005986 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5987
5988 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5989 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5990 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5991 one fails.
5992
5993 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5994 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5995 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5996
5997 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5998 server's queue.
5999
6000 Example of a header received by the application server :
6001 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6002 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6003
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006004 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6005 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006006
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006007
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006008http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6009http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006010 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 yes | no | yes | yes
6013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006014 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006015 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6016 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6019 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6021 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6022 and '-'.
6023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006024 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6025 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006026 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006027 conditions.
6028
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006029 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6030
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006031 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6032 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006034 Examples :
6035 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006036 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006037
6038
6039http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006040 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | no | yes | yes
6043
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006044 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006045 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6046 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6047 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6048 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6049 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6050 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6051 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6052 and '-'.
6053
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006054 Examples :
6055 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006058http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6059 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6060 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6061 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6062 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6064 yes | yes | yes | yes
6065 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006066 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006067 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006068 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006069 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006070
6071 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6072 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6073 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6074 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6075
6076 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6077 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6078 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6079 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6080
6081 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6082 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6083 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6084 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6085 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6086 chroot is performed.
6087
6088 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6089 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6090 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6091 considered.
6092
6093 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6094 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6095 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6096 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6097 considered as a raw string.
6098
6099 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6100 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6101 "content-type".
6102
6103 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6104 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6105 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6106 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6107 evaluated as a log-format string.
6108
6109 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6110 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6111 argument to "content-type".
6112
6113 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6114 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6115 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6116 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6117
6118 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6119 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6120 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6121 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6122 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6123 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6124 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6125 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6126
6127 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6128 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6129 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6130
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006131 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6132 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6133 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6134 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6135 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6136
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006137 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6138 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6139
6140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006141http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006142 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6143
6144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006145 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006146
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006147 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6148 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6149 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6150 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6151 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006152
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006153 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6154 supported:
6155 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6156 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6157 - allow
6158 - auth [realm <realm>]
6159 - cache-use <name>
6160 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6161 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6162 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6163 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6164 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6165 - disable-l7-retry
6166 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6167 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6168 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6169 - redirect <rule>
6170 - reject
6171 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6172 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6173 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6174 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6175 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6176 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6177 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6178 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6179 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6180 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6181 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6182 - set-dst <expr>
6183 - set-dst-port <expr>
6184 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6185 - set-log-level <level>
6186 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6187 - set-mark <mark>
6188 - set-method <fmt>
6189 - set-nice <nice>
6190 - set-path <fmt>
6191 - set-pathq <fmt>
6192 - set-priority-class <expr>
6193 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6194 - set-query <fmt>
6195 - set-src <expr>
6196 - set-src-port <expr>
6197 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6198 - set-tos <tos>
6199 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006200 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6201 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006202 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6203 - silent-drop
6204 - strict-mode { on | off }
6205 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6206 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6207 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6208 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6209 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6210 - use-service <service-name>
6211 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6212 - wait-for-handshake
6213 - cache-use <name>
6214
6215 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006217 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006218
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006219 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6220 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6221 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6222 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6223 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6224 a defaults section defining such rules.
6225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006226 Example:
6227 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6228 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6229 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006231 http-request allow if nagios
6232 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6233 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6234 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006236 Example:
6237 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6238 acl add path /addacl
6239 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006241 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006243 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6244 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006246 Example:
6247 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6248 acl setmap path /setmap
6249 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006251 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006253 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6254 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006256 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6257 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006259http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006261 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6262 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6263 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6264 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6265 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6266 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6267 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6268 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006270http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006272 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6273 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6274 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6275 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6276 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6277 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6278 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6279 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006281http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006284 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6289 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6290 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6291 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6292 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006293
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006294 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6295 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6296 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6297 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6298 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6299 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6300 instead.
6301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006302 Example:
6303 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6304 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006305
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006306http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006307
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006308 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006310http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6311 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006313 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6314 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6315 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6316 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6317 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6318 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6319 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6320 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6321 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006323 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6324 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6325 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006326 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6327
6328 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6329 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6330 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6331 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006333http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006335 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6336 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6337 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6338 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6339 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6340 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006341
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006342http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006343
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006344 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6345 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6346 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6347 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6348 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006352 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6353 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6354 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6355 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6356 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6357 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006358
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006359http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6361 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6362 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6363 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006365
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6367 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6368 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006369 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006370 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6371 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6372 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006373 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006374 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006375
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006376http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6377 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6378 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6379 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006381http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006383
6384 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6385 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6386 pointed by <resolvers>.
6387 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6388 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6389 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6390 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6391 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6392 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6393 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6394 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6395 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6396 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6397 to 0.0.0.0.
6398
6399 Example:
6400 resolvers mydns
6401 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6402 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6403 timeout retry 1s
6404 hold valid 10s
6405 hold nx 3s
6406 hold other 3s
6407 hold obsolete 0s
6408 accepted_payload_size 8192
6409
6410 frontend fe
6411 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6412 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6413 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6414
6415 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6416 # which mean DNS resolution error
6417 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6418
6419 default_backend be
6420
6421 backend b_503
6422 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6423 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6424 # 503 error page to end users
6425
6426 backend be
6427 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6428 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6429 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6430 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6431 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6432
6433 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6434 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6435
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006436http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6439 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6440 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6441 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006442 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6443 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006444
6445 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6446
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006447http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006448http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006449http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006450http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006451http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006452http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006453http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006454http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6455http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006456
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006457 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6458
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006459 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006460 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6461 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6462 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6463 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006464
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006465 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6466 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6467 the supported backend.
6468
6469 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6470 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6471 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6472 number of segments in the path.
6473
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006474 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6475 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6476 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6477 when improperly combined.
6478
6479 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6480 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6481 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6482 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6483 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6484
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006485 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006486
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006487 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6488
6489 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6490 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6491
6492 Example:
6493 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6494
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006495 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6496
6497 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6498 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6499
6500 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6501 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6502
6503 Example:
6504 - /#foo -> /
6505
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006506 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6507 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006508
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006509 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6510 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6511
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006512 Example:
6513 - /. -> /
6514 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6515 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6516 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006517
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006518 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6519 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6520
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006521 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006522 their preceding segment.
6523
6524 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6525 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6526
6527 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6528 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006529
6530 Example:
6531 - /foo/../ -> /
6532 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6533 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6534 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006535 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006536 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006537 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006538
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006539 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6540 removed as well:
6541
6542 Example:
6543 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6544 - /bar/../../ -> /
6545
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006546 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6547 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006548
6549 Example:
6550 - // -> /
6551 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6552
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006553 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6554 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6555
6556 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6557 ".", "_", and "~".
6558
6559 Example:
6560 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6561 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6562 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6563 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6564
6565 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6566 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6567
6568 Example:
6569 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6570 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6571
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006572 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006573 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006574
6575 Example:
6576 - /%6f -> /%6F
6577 - /%zz -> /%zz
6578
6579 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6580 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6581
6582 Example:
6583 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6584
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006585 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006586 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6587 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6588
6589 Example:
6590 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6591 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6592 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6597 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6598 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6599 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6600 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6605 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6606 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6607 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6610 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006611
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006612 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006613 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6614 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6615 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6616 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6617 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006618
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006619 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6620 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6621 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6622 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6623 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006624
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006625 Example:
6626 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6627
6628 # applied to:
6629 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6630
6631 # outputs:
6632 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6633
6634 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006635
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006636 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6637
6638 # applied to:
6639 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006640
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006641 # outputs:
6642 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006643
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006644http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6646
6647 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6648 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006649 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6650 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6651 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006652
6653 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6654 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6655 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6656
6657 Example:
6658 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6659 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6660
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006661 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6662 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6663 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6664 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6665
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006666http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6667 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6668
6669 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6670 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6671 query-string are replaced.
6672
6673 Example:
6674 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6675 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6676
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006677http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6679
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006680 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6681 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6682 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6683 against.
6684
6685 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6686 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6687 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006688
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006689 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6690 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6691 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6692 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6693 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6694 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6695 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6696 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6697 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006698 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6699 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006700
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006701 Example:
6702 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6703 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006704
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006705 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6706 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6709 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006710
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006711 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6712 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6713 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6714 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006715
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006716 Example:
6717 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006718
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006719 # applied to:
6720 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006721
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006722 # outputs:
6723 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006724
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006725http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6726 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6727 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006728 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006729 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6730
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006731 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006732 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6733 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006734 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006735 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006736 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006737 are followed to create the response :
6738
6739 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6740 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6741 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6742 ignored.
6743
6744 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6745 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006746 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006747 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6748 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006749
6750 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6751 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6752 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006753 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006754 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006755
6756 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6757 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6758 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006759 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006760 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006761 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006762
6763 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6764 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6765 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6766 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6767 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6768 as a raw content.
6769
6770 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6771 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6772 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6773 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6774 considered as a raw string.
6775
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006776 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006777 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6778 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6779 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6780
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006781 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6782 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006783 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006784
6785 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6786
6787 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006788 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006789 if { path /ping }
6790
6791 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6792 if { path /favicon.ico }
6793
6794 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6795 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6796 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6797
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006798http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799
6800 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6801 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6802 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6803 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6804 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6805 at this index.
6806 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6807 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006809http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6810http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6813 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6814 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006815
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006816http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6817 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6818 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6819 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6820 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6821 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6822 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6823 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6824 at this index.
6825 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6826 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6827
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006828http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6829 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006830
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006831 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6832 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6833 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6834 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006836http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6837 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6838
6839 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6840 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6841 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6842 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6843 agent name must be used.
6844
6845 Arguments:
6846 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6847
6848 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6849 configuration.
6850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006851http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006853 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6854 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6855 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6856 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6857 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 Arguments:
6860 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6861 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006863 Example:
6864 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6865 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006867 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6868 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006870http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006872 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6873 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6874 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006876 Arguments:
6877 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6878 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006879
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006880 Example:
6881 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6882 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006884 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6885 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6886 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006887
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006888http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006889
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006890 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6891 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6892 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6893 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6894 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006896 Example:
6897 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6898 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6899 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6900 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6901 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6902 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6903 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6904 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6905 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006907http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006909 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6910 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6911 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6912 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6913 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006915http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6916 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006918 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6919 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6920 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6921 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6922 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6923 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6924 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6925 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6926 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006928http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006929
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006930 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6931 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6932 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6933 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6934 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6935 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6936 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006937 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6938 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006941
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006942 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6943 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6944 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006948 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6949 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6950 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6951 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6952 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6953 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6954 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6955 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006957http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006959 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6960 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6961 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6962 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6963 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6964 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006966 Example :
6967 # prepend the host name before the path
6968 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006969
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006970http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6971
6972 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6973 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6974 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006976http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006978 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6979 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6980 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6981 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6982 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006984http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006986 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6987 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6988 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6989 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6990 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6991 values have higher priority.
6992 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6993 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6994 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6995 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6996 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006998http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006999
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007000 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7001 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7002 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7003 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7004 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7005 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7006 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007008 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007009
7010 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007011 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7012 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007014http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7015 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7016 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7017 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007018 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7019 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007020
7021 Arguments :
7022 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7023 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007024
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007025 See also "option forwardfor".
7026
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007027 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007028 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7029 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7030
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007031 # After the masking this will track connections
7032 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7033 http-request track-sc0 src
7034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007035 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7036 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7037
7038http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7039
7040 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7041 expression.
7042
7043 Arguments:
7044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7045 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007046
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007047 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7049 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7050
7051 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7052 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7053 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7054
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007055http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7057
7058 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7059 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7060 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7061 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7062 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7063
7064 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7065 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7066 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7067 results.
7068
7069 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007070 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7071 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007073http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7074
7075 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7076 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7077 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7078 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7079 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7080 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7081 information from the request.
7082
7083 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7084
7085http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086
7087 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7088 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
7089 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
7090 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
7091 path and the query string.
7092 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7093
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007094http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7095http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007096
7097 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7098 inline.
7099
7100 Arguments:
7101 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7102 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7106 (request and response)
7107 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7108 processing
7109 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7110 processing
7111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7112 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7113 and '_'.
7114
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007115 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7116 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007117 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007118 conditions.
7119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007120 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7121 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007122
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007123 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7124 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7125
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007126 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007128 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007130http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7131
7132 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7133 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7134 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7135 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7136 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7137 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7138 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7139 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7140 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7141 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7142 action.
7143 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7144 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7145 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7146 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7147 you fully understand how it works.
7148
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007149http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007150
7151 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7152 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7153 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7154 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7155 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007156 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007157 processing.
7158
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007159 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007160 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7161 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7162 rules evaluation.
7163
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007164http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7165http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7166 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7167 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7168 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007170
7171 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7172 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7173 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007174 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7175 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7176 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7177 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7178 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7179 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007180 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007181 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7182 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7183 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007184 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007185 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7186 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7187 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7188 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7189 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007190
7191http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7192http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7193http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7194
7195 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7196 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7197 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7198 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007199 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007200 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7201 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7202 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7203 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7204 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7205 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7206 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7207
7208 Arguments :
7209 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7210 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7211 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7212 select which table entry to update the counters.
7213
7214 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7215 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7216 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7217 that table until the session ends.
7218
7219 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7220 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7221 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7222 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7223 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7224 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7225 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7226 useful information.
7227
7228 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7229 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7230 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7231 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7232 checks that make use of it.
7233
7234http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7235
7236 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007237
7238 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007239 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007240
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007241http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7242
7243 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7244 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7245 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7246 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7247 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7248 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7249
7250 Arguments :
7251 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7252
7253 Example:
7254 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7255
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007256http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7258
7259 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7260 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7261 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7262 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7263 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7264 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7265 http-buffer-request".
7266
7267 Arguments :
7268
7269 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7270 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7271
7272 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007273 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007274 bytes.
7275
7276 Example:
7277 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7278
7279 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007281http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007283 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7284 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7285 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007286
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007288http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007289 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7290
7291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007292 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007293
7294 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7295 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7296 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7297 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7298 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7299 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7300
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007301 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7302 supported:
7303 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7304 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7305 - allow
7306 - cache-store <name>
7307 - capture <sample> id <id>
7308 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7309 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7310 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7311 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7312 - redirect <rule>
7313 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7314 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7315 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7316 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7317 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7318 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7319 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7320 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7321 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7322 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7323 - set-log-level <level>
7324 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7325 - set-mark <mark>
7326 - set-nice <nice>
7327 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7328 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007329 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7330 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007331 - silent-drop
7332 - strict-mode { on | off }
7333 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7334 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7335 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7336 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7337 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7338
7339 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007341 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007342
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007343 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7344 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7345 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7346 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7347 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7348 a defaults section defining such rules.
7349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350 Example:
7351 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007353 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7356 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007358 Example:
7359 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007363 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7364 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007365
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007366 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7367 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007369http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007370
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007371 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7372 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007373
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007374http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007376 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007377 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7378 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007380http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007381
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007382 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7383 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007384
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007385http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007386
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007387 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007388
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7392 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7393 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7394 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7395 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7396 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7397 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007398
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007399 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7400 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7401 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7402 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7403 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007404
7405 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7406 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7407 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7408 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007410http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007411
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007412 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7413 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007414
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007415http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007417 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7418 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007421
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007422 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7423 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007424
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007425http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7426http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7427 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7428 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7429 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7430 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007431
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007432 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7433 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7434 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007435 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007436 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7437 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7438 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007439 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007440 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007442http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007444 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7445 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7446 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7447 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7448 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7449 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007451http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007454 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7455 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007457 Example:
7458 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007460 # applied to:
7461 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007463 # outputs:
7464 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007466 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007468http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7469 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007470
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007471 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007472 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007473
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007474 Example:
7475 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007477 # applied to:
7478 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007480 # outputs:
7481 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007482
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007483http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7484 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7485 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007486 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007487 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7488
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007489 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7490 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7491 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007492
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007493http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007494http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7495http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007496
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007497 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7498 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7499 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7500 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007501
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007502http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007504http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007506http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007508
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007509 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7510 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7511 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007512
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007513http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007515
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007516 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7517 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007518
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007519http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007520
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007521 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7522 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7523 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7524 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007525
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007526http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7527
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007528 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7529 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007530
7531http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007533 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7534 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007535
7536http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7537
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007538 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7539 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7540 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007541
7542http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7543
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007544 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7545 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007546
7547http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7549
7550 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7551 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7552 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7553 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007554
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007555 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007556 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7557 http-response set-status 431
7558 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7559 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007560
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007561http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007563 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007564 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7565 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007566
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007567http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7568http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007569
7570 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007571 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7572 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007574http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007576 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7577 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007578 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7579 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007580
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007581http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007582
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007583 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7584 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007586http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7587http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7588http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007589
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007590 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7591 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7592 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007593
7594http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7595
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007596 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007597 about <var-name>.
7598
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007599http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7600 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7601
7602 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007603 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7604 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007605
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007606
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007607http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7608 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7609
7610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 yes | no | yes | yes
7612
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007613 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007614 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7615 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7616 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007617
7618 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7619
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007620 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7621 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7622 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7623 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7624 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7625 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7626 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007627 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007628 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7629 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007630
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007631 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7632 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7633 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7634 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7635 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7636 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7637 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007638 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7639 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7640 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7641 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7642 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7643 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007644
7645 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7646 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7647 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7648 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7649 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7650 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7651 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7652 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007653 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007654 downsides of rare connection failures.
7655
7656 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7657 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7658 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7659 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7660 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7661 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007662 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007663 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7664 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7665 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7666 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7667 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7668
7669 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007670 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7671 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7672 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7673 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007674
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007675 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7676 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007677
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007678 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007679
7680 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7681 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7682 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7683
7684 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7685
7686
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007687http-send-name-header [<header>]
7688 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007691 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007692 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7693
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007694 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7695 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7696 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7697 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7698 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7699 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7700 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7701 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7702 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7703 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7704 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7705 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7706 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7707 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7708 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7709 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007710
7711 See also : "server"
7712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007713id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007714 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 no | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments : none
7718
7719 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7720 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7721 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007722
7723
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007724ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7725 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007727 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007728
7729 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7730 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7731 and running).
7732
7733 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7734 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7735 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007736 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007737 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7738
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007739 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7740 "unless" condition is met.
7741
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007742 Example:
7743 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7744 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7745 ignore-persist if url_static
7746
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007747 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7748
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007749load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7750 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7752 yes | no | yes | yes
7753
7754 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7755 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7756 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007757 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007758 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007759 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7760 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7761 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007763 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007764 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007765 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007766
7767 Arguments:
7768 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7769 named "server-state-file".
7770
7771 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7772 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7773 name is used as a file name.
7774
7775 none don't load any stat for this backend
7776
7777 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007778 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7779 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7780 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007781 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007782 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007783
7784 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7785 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7786
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007787 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007789 global
7790 stats socket /tmp/socket
7791 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007792
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007793 defaults
7794 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007795
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007796 backend bk
7797 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7798 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007799
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007800
7801 Then one can run :
7802
7803 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7804
7805 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7806
7807 1
7808 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7809 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7810 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7811
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007812 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007813
7814 global
7815 stats socket /tmp/socket
7816 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7817
7818 defaults
7819 load-server-state-from-file local
7820
7821 backend bk
7822 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7823 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7824
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007825
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007826 Then one can run :
7827
7828 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7829
7830 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7831
7832 1
7833 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7834 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7835 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7836
7837 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7838 "show servers state"
7839
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007841log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007842log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007843 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007844no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007845 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7847 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007848
7849 Prefix :
7850 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7851 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7852 prefix does not allow arguments.
7853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007854 Arguments :
7855 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7856 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7857 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7858 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7859 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7860 parameter.
7861
7862 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7863 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7864
7865 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7866 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7867 standard syslog port).
7868
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007869 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7870 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7871 standard syslog port).
7872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007873 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7874 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7875 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007876 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007877
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007878 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7879 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7880 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7881 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7882 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7883 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7884 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7885 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7886 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7887 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7888 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7889 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007890 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007891 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7892 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7893 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007894 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7895 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007896
7897 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7898 and "fd@2", see above.
7899
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007900 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7901 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7902 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7903 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7904 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7905 having the logs instantly available.
7906
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007907 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7908 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7909 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007911 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7912 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007913
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007914 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7915 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7916 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7917 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7918 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7919 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7920 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7921 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7922 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7923 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007924 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007925
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007926 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7927 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7928 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7929 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7930 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7931
7932 <sample_size>
7933 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7934 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7935 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7936 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7937 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7938
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007939 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7940 one of the following :
7941
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007942 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7943 field is stripped. This is the default.
7944 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7945 rfc3164.
7946
7947 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007948 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7949
7950 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7951 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7952
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007953 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7954 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7955 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7956 designed to be used with a local log server.
7957
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007958 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7959 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7960 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7961 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7962 systemd logger consumes.
7963
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007964 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7965 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7966 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7967 used with a local log server.
7968
7969 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7970 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7971 designed to be used with a local log server.
7972
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007973 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7974 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7975 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7976 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7979
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007980 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7981 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7982 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7983
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007984 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7985 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7986 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7987 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007988
7989 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7990 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7991 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007992 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7993 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7994 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7995 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7996 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007997
7998 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7999
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008000 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8001 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8002 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008003
8004 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8005 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8006 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8007 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8008
8009 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8010 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008011
8012 Example :
8013 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008014 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8015 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8016 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008017 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008018 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8019 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008020 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008022
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008023log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008024 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008027
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008028 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8029 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8030 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8031 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8032 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008033 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8034 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008035
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008036 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8037 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008038
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008039log-format-sd <string>
8040 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 yes | yes | yes | no
8043
8044 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8045 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8046 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8047 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8048 which covers the log format string in depth.
8049
8050 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8051 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8052
8053 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8054 log format to "rfc5424".
8055
8056 Example :
8057 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8058
8059
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008060log-tag <string>
8061 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | yes | yes | yes
8064
8065 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8066 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008067 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008068 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8069 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8070 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8071 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8072 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8073 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008074
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008075max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8076 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8078 yes | no | yes | yes
8079
8080 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8081 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8082 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8083 servers.
8084
8085 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008086 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008087 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8088 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8089 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008090 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008091 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8092 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8093 picking a different server.
8094
8095 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8096 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8097 even if they have to be queued.
8098
8099 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8100 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8101
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008102max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8103 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8104 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8105 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008106
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008107maxconn <conns>
8108 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | yes | yes | no
8111 Arguments :
8112 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8113 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8114 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8115 closes.
8116
8117 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008118 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008119 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8120 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008121 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8122 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8123 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8124 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008125
8126 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8127 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8128 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8129
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008130 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8131 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008132
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008133 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8134
8135
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008136mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008137 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | yes | yes | yes
8140 Arguments :
8141 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8142 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8143 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8144 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8145
8146 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8147 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8148 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8149 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8150 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008152 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8153 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8154 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008155
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008156 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008157 defaults http_instances
8158 mode http
8159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008160
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008161monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008162 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8164 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008165 Arguments :
8166 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8167 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008168 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008169 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8170 backend and its backup.
8171
8172 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8173 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8174 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8175 servers in a list of backends.
8176
8177 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8178 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8179 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008180 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008181 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8182 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008183 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008184 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8185 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008186
8187 Example:
8188 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008189 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008190 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8191 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8192 monitor-uri /site_alive
8193 monitor fail if site_dead
8194
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008195 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008196
8197
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008198monitor-uri <uri>
8199 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8201 yes | yes | yes | no
8202 Arguments :
8203 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8204 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8205
8206 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8207 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8208 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8209 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8210 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8211 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8212 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8213 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8214
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008215 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008216 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8217 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8218 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8219 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8220 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8221 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008222
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008223 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8224 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8225 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8226 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8227
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008228 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008229 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008230 frontend www
8231 mode http
8232 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8233
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008234 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008236
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008237option abortonclose
8238no option abortonclose
8239 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8241 yes | no | yes | yes
8242 Arguments : none
8243
8244 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8245 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8246 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8247 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008248 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008249 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8250 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8251 encountered while delivering the response.
8252
8253 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8254 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8255 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8256 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8257 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8258 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008260 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008261 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008262 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8263 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8264 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008266 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8267 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008268 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8269 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8270 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8271 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8272 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8273 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008274 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275
8276 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8277 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8278
8279 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8280
8281
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008282option accept-invalid-http-request
8283no option accept-invalid-http-request
8284 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8286 yes | yes | yes | no
8287 Arguments : none
8288
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008289 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008290 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008291 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008292 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8293 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8294 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8295 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8296 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008297 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8298 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8299 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8300 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008301 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008302 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008303 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8304 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8305 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008306
8307 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8308 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8309 been confirmed.
8310
8311 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8312 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008313 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8314 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008315 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8316
8317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8319
8320 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8321 stats socket.
8322
8323
8324option accept-invalid-http-response
8325no option accept-invalid-http-response
8326 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 yes | no | yes | yes
8329 Arguments : none
8330
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008331 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008332 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008334 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8335 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8336 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8337 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8338 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008339 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8340 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8341 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008342
8343 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8344 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8345 been confirmed.
8346
8347 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8348 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8349 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8350 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8351
8352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8354
8355 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8356 stats socket.
8357
8358
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008359option allbackups
8360no option allbackups
8361 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8363 yes | no | yes | yes
8364 Arguments : none
8365
8366 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8367 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8368 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8369 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8370 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8371 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8372 order between the backup servers anymore.
8373
8374 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8375 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8376
8377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8379
8380
8381option checkcache
8382no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008383 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | no | yes | yes
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8389 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008390 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008391 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8392 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008393 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008394
8395 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008396 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008397 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008398 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8399 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008400 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008401 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008402 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8403 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008404 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008405 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8406 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008407 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8409 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8410 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8411 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8412 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8414 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8415 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8416 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8417
8418 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008419 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8420 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8421 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8422 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008423
8424 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8425 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008426 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008428
8429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8431
8432
8433option clitcpka
8434no option clitcpka
8435 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8437 yes | yes | yes | no
8438 Arguments : none
8439
8440 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8441 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008442 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008443 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8444
8445 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8446 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8447 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8448 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8449
8450 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8451 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8452 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8453 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8454 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8455
8456 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8457
8458 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8459 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8460 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8461
8462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8464
8465 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8466
8467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008468option contstats
8469 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | yes | yes | no
8472 Arguments : none
8473
8474 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8475 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8476 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008477 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008478 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8479 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8480 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8481 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8482 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008483
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008484option disable-h2-upgrade
8485no option disable-h2-upgrade
8486 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8487 connection.
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | yes | yes | no
8490 Arguments : none
8491
8492 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8493 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8494 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8495 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008496 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8497 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8498 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8499 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8500 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8501 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008502
8503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008505
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008506option dontlog-normal
8507no option dontlog-normal
8508 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8510 yes | yes | yes | no
8511 Arguments : none
8512
8513 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8514 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8515 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8516 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8517 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8518 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8519 logged.
8520
8521 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8522 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8523 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008525 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008526 logging.
8527
8528
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008529option dontlognull
8530no option dontlognull
8531 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8533 yes | yes | yes | no
8534 Arguments : none
8535
8536 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8537 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8538 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8539 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8540 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8541 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008542 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8543 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8544 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008545
8546 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008547 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008548 would not be logged.
8549
8550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8552
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008553 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008554 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008555
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008556
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008557option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008558 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | yes | yes | yes
8561 Arguments :
8562 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8563 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008564 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008565 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008566
8567 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8568 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8569 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8570 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8571 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8572 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8573 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008574 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8575 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8576 possible that the client has already brought one.
8577
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008578 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008579 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008581 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008583 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008584
8585 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8586 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8587 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8588 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8589 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8590 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008591 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008592
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008593 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8594 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008595 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008596 are under the control of the end-user.
8597
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008598 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008599 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8600 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008601 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8602 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8603 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008605 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008606 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8607 frontend www
8608 mode http
8609 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8610
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008611 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8612 backend www
8613 mode http
8614 option forwardfor header X-Client
8615
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008616 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008617 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008618
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008619
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008620option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8621no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8622 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8624 yes | yes | yes | no
8625 Arguments : none
8626
8627 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8628 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8629 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8630 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8631 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8632 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8633 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8634
8635 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8636 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8637 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8638 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8639 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8640 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8641 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8642 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8643 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8644 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8645
8646 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8647
8648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8650
8651 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8652 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8653
8654
8655option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8656no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8657 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8659 yes | no | yes | yes
8660 Arguments : none
8661
8662 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8663 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8664 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8665 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8666 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8667 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8668 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8669
8670 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8671 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8672 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8673 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8674 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8675 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8676 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8677 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8678 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8679 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8680
8681 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8682
8683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8685
8686 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8687 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8688
8689
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008690option http-buffer-request
8691no option http-buffer-request
8692 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | yes | yes | yes
8695 Arguments : none
8696
8697 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8698 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8699 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8700 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8701 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8702 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008703 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8704 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8705 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8706 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008707
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008708 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8709 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008710
8711
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008712option http-ignore-probes
8713no option http-ignore-probes
8714 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8716 yes | yes | yes | no
8717 Arguments : none
8718
8719 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8720 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8721 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8722 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8723 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8724 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8725 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8726 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8727 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008728 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8729 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008730 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8731
8732 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8733 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8734 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8735 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8736 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8737 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8738 are often the only way to detect them.
8739
8740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8742
8743 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8744
8745
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008746option http-keep-alive
8747no option http-keep-alive
8748 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 yes | yes | yes | yes
8751 Arguments : none
8752
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008753 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8754 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008755 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8756 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008757 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8758 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8759 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008760
8761 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8762 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008763 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8764 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8765 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8766 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8767 situations where this option may be useful :
8768
8769 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008770 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008771
8772 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8773 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8774
8775 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8776 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8777 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8778 request.
8779
8780 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8781 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008782 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8783 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8784 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008785
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008786 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8787 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8788 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8789 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8790 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8791 not set.
8792
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008793 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8794 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8795 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008796
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008797 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008798 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008799 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008800
8801
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008802option http-no-delay
8803no option http-no-delay
8804 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8806 yes | yes | yes | yes
8807 Arguments : none
8808
8809 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8810 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8811 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8812 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8813 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8814 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8815 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008816 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008817 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8818 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8819 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8820 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8821 affected.
8822
8823 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8824 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8825 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8826 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8827 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8828 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8829 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8830 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8831 latency environments.
8832
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008833 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8834
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008835
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008836option http-pretend-keepalive
8837no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008838 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008840 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008841 Arguments : none
8842
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008843 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008844 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8845 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8846 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008847 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008848 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8849 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8850 consider the response complete.
8851
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008852 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008853 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008854 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008855 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008856 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008857 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8858
8859 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8860 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8861 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8862 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008863 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8864 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008865 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8866
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008867 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8868 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8869 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8870 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8871 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8872 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008873
8874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8876
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008877 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008878 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008879
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008880
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008881option http-server-close
8882no option http-server-close
8883 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8885 yes | yes | yes | yes
8886 Arguments : none
8887
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008888 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8889 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8890 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8891 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008892 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8893 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8894 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8895 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8896 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8897 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8898 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8899 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8900 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8901 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8902 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008903
8904 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8905 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8906 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8907 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008908 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8909 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008910
8911 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8912 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008913 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8914 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8915 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008916
8917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8919
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008920 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8921 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008922
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008923option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008924no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008925 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8927 yes | yes | yes | no
8928 Arguments : none
8929
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008930 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008931 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8932 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8933 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8934 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8935 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008936 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008937
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008938 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008939 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008940 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8941 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8942 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008943
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008944 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8945 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8946 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8947 front of an existing proxy.
8948
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008949 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8950
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008951 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008952
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008953option httpchk
8954option httpchk <uri>
8955option httpchk <method> <uri>
8956option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008957 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8959 yes | no | yes | yes
8960 Arguments :
8961 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8962 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8963 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8964 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8965 ones.
8966
8967 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8968 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8969 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8970
8971 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8972 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8973 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008974 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008975
8976 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8977 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8978 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8979 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8980 the lack of any response.
8981
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008982 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8983 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8984 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8985 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8986
8987 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8988 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8989 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008990
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008991 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8992 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008993 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008994 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008995 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008997 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8998 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8999 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
9000 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
9001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009002 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009003 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9004 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9005 backend https_relay
9006 mode tcp
9007 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9008 http-check send hdr Host www
9009 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009010
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009011 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9012 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9013 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009014
9015
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009016option httpclose
9017no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009018 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9020 yes | yes | yes | yes
9021 Arguments : none
9022
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009023 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9024 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9025 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9026 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009027 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009028
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009029 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9030 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009031 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009032 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9033 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009034
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009035 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9036 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9037 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009038
9039 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9040 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009041 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9042 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9043 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009044
9045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9047
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009048 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009049
9050
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009051option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009052 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009054 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009055 Arguments :
9056 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9057 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9058 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009060 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009061
9062 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9063 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9064 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9065 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9066 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9067 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9068 ports.
9069
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009070 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9071 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009072
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009073 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009075 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009076
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009077option httpslog
9078 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9080 yes | yes | yes | no
9081
9082 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9083 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9084 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9085 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9086 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9087 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9088 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9089
9090 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9091
9092 See also : section 8 about logging.
9093
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009094
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009095option independent-streams
9096no option independent-streams
9097 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9099 yes | yes | yes | yes
9100 Arguments : none
9101
9102 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9103 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9104 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9105 receive data or not.
9106
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009107 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009108 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9109 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9110 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9111 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9112 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9113 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9114 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9115 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9116 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9117 socket buffers.
9118
9119 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9120 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9121 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9122 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9123 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9124
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009125 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009126
9127
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009128option ldap-check
9129 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9131 yes | no | yes | yes
9132 Arguments : none
9133
9134 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9135 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9136 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9137 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9138
9139 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9140 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9141
9142 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9143 configure it.
9144
9145 Example :
9146 option ldap-check
9147
9148 See also : "option httpchk"
9149
9150
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009151option external-check
9152 Use external processes for server health checks
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | no | yes | yes
9155
9156 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9157 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9158 command".
9159
9160 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9161
9162 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9163
9164
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009165option idle-close-on-response
9166no option idle-close-on-response
9167 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9169 yes | yes | yes | no
9170 Arguments : none
9171
9172 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9173 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9174 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9175 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9176 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9177 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9178 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9179 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9180 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9181
9182 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9183 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9184
9185 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9186 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9187 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9188 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9189
9190 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9191 "hard-stop-after"
9192
9193
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009194option log-health-checks
9195no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009196 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 yes | no | yes | yes
9199 Arguments : none
9200
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009201 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9202 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9203 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009204
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009205 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9206 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9207 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9208 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9209 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009211 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009212 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009213
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009214 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9215 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9216 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009217
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009218
9219option log-separate-errors
9220no option log-separate-errors
9221 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9223 yes | yes | yes | no
9224 Arguments : none
9225
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009226 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009227 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9228 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9229 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9230 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9231 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9232 provides very important information.
9233
9234 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9235 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9236 error logs.
9237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009238 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009239 logging.
9240
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009241
9242option logasap
9243no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009244 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9246 yes | yes | yes | no
9247 Arguments : none
9248
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009249 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9250 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9251 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9252 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9253
9254 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9255 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9256 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9257 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9258 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009259 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009260 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9261 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9262 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9263 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009264 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009265
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009266 Examples :
9267 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9268 mode http
9269 option httplog
9270 option logasap
9271 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9272
9273 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9274 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9275 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9276 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009278 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009279 logging.
9280
9281
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009282option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009283 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9285 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009286 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009287 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9288 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009289 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9290 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009291
9292 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9293 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009294 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009295 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009296 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9297 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9298 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009299
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009300 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9301 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9302 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009303
9304 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009306 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9307 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9308 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9309 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9310 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9311 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9312 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9313
9314 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9315 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009316
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009317 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009318
9319 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9320 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9321 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9322 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009323 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009324 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009325
9326 See also: "option httpchk"
9327
9328
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009329option nolinger
9330no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009331 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9333 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009334 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009335
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009337 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9338 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9339 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9340 connections.
9341
9342 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9343 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009344 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9345 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9346 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9347 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9348 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9349 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9350 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9351 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9352 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9353 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9354 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9355 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9356 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009357
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009358 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9359 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9360 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9361 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9362 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009363
9364 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9365 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009366 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009367 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009368 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009369
9370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9372
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009373 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9374 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009375
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009376option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9377 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 yes | yes | yes | yes
9380 Arguments :
9381 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9382 matching <network>
9383 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9384 header name.
9385
9386 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9387 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9388 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9389 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9390 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9391 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9392 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9393 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9394 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9395 possible that the client has already brought one.
9396
9397 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9398 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9399 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9400 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9401 header and requires different one.
9402
9403 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9404 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9405 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009406 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9407 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9408 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9409 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9410 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009411
9412 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9413 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9414 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9415 both are defined.
9416
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009417 Examples :
9418 # Original Destination address
9419 frontend www
9420 mode http
9421 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9422
9423 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9424 backend www
9425 mode http
9426 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9427
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009428 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009429
9430
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009431option persist
9432no option persist
9433 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009436 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009437
9438 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9439 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9440 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9441 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9442 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9443 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9444 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9445 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9446 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9447 redirected to another valid server.
9448
9449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9451
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009452 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009453
9454
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009455option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9456 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9458 yes | no | yes | yes
9459 Arguments :
9460 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9461 PostgreSQL server.
9462
9463 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9464 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9465 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9466 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9467
9468 See also: "option httpchk"
9469
9470
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009471option prefer-last-server
9472no option prefer-last-server
9473 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9475 yes | no | yes | yes
9476 Arguments : none
9477
9478 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009479 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009480 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9481 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009482 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009483 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009484 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009485 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9486 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009487 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009488 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009489 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9490 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9491 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009492 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9493 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9494 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009495
9496 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9497 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9498
9499 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9500
9501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009502option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009503option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009504no option redispatch
9505 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9507 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009508 Arguments :
9509 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9510 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9511 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009512 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009513 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009514 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009515 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9516 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9517 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009519
9520 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9521 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9522 be able to access the service anymore.
9523
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009524 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9525 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009526
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009527 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9528 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9529 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9530 following order:
9531
9532 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9533
9534 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9535 list, or
9536
9537 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9538
9539 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9540 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9541
9542 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9543 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9544 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9545 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9546
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009547 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009548 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9549 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009551 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9552 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9553
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009554 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009555
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009556
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009557option redis-check
9558 Use redis health checks for server testing
9559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9560 yes | no | yes | yes
9561 Arguments : none
9562
9563 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9564 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9565 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9566 find the "+PONG" response message.
9567
9568 Example :
9569 option redis-check
9570
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009571 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009572
9573
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009574option smtpchk
9575option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9576 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9578 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009579 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009580 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009581 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009582 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9583
9584 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9585 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9586 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9587
9588 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9589 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9590 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9591 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9592 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9593 dead server.
9594
9595 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9596 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009597 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009598 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9599
9600 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9601 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9602 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9603 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009604 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009605
9606 Example :
9607 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9608
9609 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009612option socket-stats
9613no option socket-stats
9614
9615 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9617 yes | yes | yes | no
9618
9619 Arguments : none
9620
9621
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009622option splice-auto
9623no option splice-auto
9624 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9626 yes | yes | yes | yes
9627 Arguments : none
9628
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009629 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009630 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009632 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009633 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009634 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9635 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9636 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9637 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9638
9639 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9640 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9641 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9642 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9643 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9644 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9645 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9646 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9647 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9648 keyword.
9649
9650 Example :
9651 option splice-auto
9652
9653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9655
9656 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9657 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9658
9659
9660option splice-request
9661no option splice-request
9662 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9664 yes | yes | yes | yes
9665 Arguments : none
9666
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009667 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009668 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009669 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9670 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9671 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9672 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9673
9674 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9675
9676 Example :
9677 option splice-request
9678
9679 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9680 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9681
9682 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9683 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9684
9685
9686option splice-response
9687no option splice-response
9688 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9690 yes | yes | yes | yes
9691 Arguments : none
9692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009693 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009694 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009695 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9696 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9697 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9698 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9699
9700 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9701
9702 Example :
9703 option splice-response
9704
9705 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9706 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9707
9708 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9709 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9710
9711
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009712option spop-check
9713 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9715 no | no | no | yes
9716 Arguments : none
9717
9718 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9719 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9720 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9721 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9722
9723 Example :
9724 option spop-check
9725
9726 See also : "option httpchk"
9727
9728
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009729option srvtcpka
9730no option srvtcpka
9731 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9733 yes | no | yes | yes
9734 Arguments : none
9735
9736 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9737 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009738 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009739 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9740
9741 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9742 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9743 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9744 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9745
9746 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9747 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9748 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9749 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9750 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9751
9752 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9753
9754 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9755 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9756 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9757
9758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9760
9761 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9762
9763
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009764option ssl-hello-chk
9765 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9767 yes | no | yes | yes
9768 Arguments : none
9769
9770 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9771 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9772 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9773 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9774 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9775 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9776 hello message.
9777
9778 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9779 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9780 messages, which is appreciable.
9781
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009782 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009783 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9784 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009785
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009786 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9787
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009788
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009789option tcp-check
9790 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9792 yes | no | yes | yes
9793
9794 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9795 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9796
9797 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9798 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9799 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9800
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009801 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009802 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9803 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9804 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9805 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9806 only.
9807
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009808 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009809 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009810 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9811 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9812 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9813
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009814 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009815 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9816 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009817 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009818 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9819 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9820 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9821 the respective protocols.
9822 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009823 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009824
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009825 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009826
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009827 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9828 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9829 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9830 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009831
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009832 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9833 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9834 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009835
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009836
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009837 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009838 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009839 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009840 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009841
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009843 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009844 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009845
9846 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9847 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009848 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009849 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009850 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009851 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009852 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009853 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009854 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9855 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009856 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009857 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9858 tcp-check expect string +OK
9859
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009860 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009861 (send many headers before analyzing)
9862 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009863 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009864 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9865 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9866 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9867 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009868 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009869
9870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009871 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009872
9873
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009874option tcp-smart-accept
9875no option tcp-smart-accept
9876 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9878 yes | yes | yes | no
9879 Arguments : none
9880
9881 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9882 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9883 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9884 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9885 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9886 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9887
9888 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9889 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9890 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9891 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9892
9893 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9894 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9895 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009896 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009897
9898 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9899 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9900 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9901
9902 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9903 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9904 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9905
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009906 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9907
9908
9909option tcp-smart-connect
9910no option tcp-smart-connect
9911 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9913 yes | no | yes | yes
9914 Arguments : none
9915
9916 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9917 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9918 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9919 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9920 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9921
9922 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9923 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9924 complex.
9925
9926 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9927 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9928 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9929
9930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9932
9933 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9934
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009935
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009936option tcpka
9937 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9939 yes | yes | yes | yes
9940 Arguments : none
9941
9942 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9943 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009944 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009945 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9946
9947 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9948 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9949 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9950 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9951
9952 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9953 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9954 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9955 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9956 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9957
9958 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9959
9960 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9961 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9962 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9963 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9964 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9965 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9966 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9967 backends.
9968
9969 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9970
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009971
9972option tcplog
9973 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009975 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009976 Arguments : none
9977
9978 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9979 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9980 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9981 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9982 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9983 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9984 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9985 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9986
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009987 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009989 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009990
9991
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009992option transparent
9993no option transparent
9994 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009996 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009997 Arguments : none
9998
9999 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10000 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10001 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10002 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10003 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10004 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10005 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10006 appropriate server.
10007
10008 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10009 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10010
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010011 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010012 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010013
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010014
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010015external-check command <command>
10016 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10018 yes | no | yes | yes
10019
10020 Arguments :
10021 <command> is the external command to run
10022
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010023 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10024
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010025 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010026
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010027 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10028 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10029 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10030 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10031 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10032 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010033
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010034 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10035
10036 Environment variables :
10037 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10038 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10039
10040 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10041
10042 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10043
10044 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10045 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10046 for a UNIX socket).
10047
10048 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10049
10050 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10051
10052 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10053
10054 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10055
10056 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10057
10058 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10059 socket).
10060
10061 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10062 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10063
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010064 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10065
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010066 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10067 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10068 failed.
10069
10070 Example :
10071 external-check command /bin/true
10072
10073 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10074
10075
10076external-check path <path>
10077 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10079 yes | no | yes | yes
10080
10081 Arguments :
10082 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10083
10084 The default path is "".
10085
10086 Example :
10087 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10088
10089 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10090 "external-check command"
10091
10092
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010093persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010094persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010095 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 yes | no | yes | yes
10098 Arguments :
10099 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010100 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10101 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010102
10103 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10104 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010105 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010106 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10107 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10108 forwarded to this server.
10109
10110 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10111 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10112 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010113 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010114 a single "listen" section.
10115
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010116 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10117 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10118 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10119
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010120 Example :
10121 listen tse-farm
10122 bind :3389
10123 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10124 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10125 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10126 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10127 persist rdp-cookie
10128 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010129 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010130 balance rdp-cookie
10131 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10132 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10133
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010134 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010135
10136
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010137rate-limit sessions <rate>
10138 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10140 yes | yes | yes | no
10141 Arguments :
10142 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10143 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10144
10145 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10146 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10147 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010148 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010149 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10150 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10151
10152 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10153 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10154 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10155 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10156
10157 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10158 listen smtp
10159 mode tcp
10160 bind :25
10161 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010162 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010163
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010164 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10165 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10166 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010167
10168 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10169
10170
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010171redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10172redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10173redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010174 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10176 no | yes | yes | yes
10177
10178 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010179 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010180
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010181 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010182 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010183 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10184 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10185 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010186
10187 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10188 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10189 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10190 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10191 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010192 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10193 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10194 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10195 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010196
10197 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10198 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10199 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10200 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10201 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10202 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010203 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010204 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010205 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10206 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10207 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010208
10209 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010210 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10211 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10212 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010213 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010214 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10215 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10216 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10217 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010218
10219 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010220 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010221
10222 - "drop-query"
10223 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10224 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10225 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10226 with a location-type redirect.
10227
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010228 - "append-slash"
10229 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10230 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10231 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10232 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10233
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010234 - "ignore-empty"
10235 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10236 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10237 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10238 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10239 of known paths using a simple map.
10240
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010241 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10242 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10243 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10244 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10245 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10246 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10247 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10248
10249 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10250 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10251 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10252 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10253 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10254 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10255 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010256
10257 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10258 acl clear dst_port 80
10259 acl secure dst_port 8080
10260 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010261 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010262 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010263 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10264
10265 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010266 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10267 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10268 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010269 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010270
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010271 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10272 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10273 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10274
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010275 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010276 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010277
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010278 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010279 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10280 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10281 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010282
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010283 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10284 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10285 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010287 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010288
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010289
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010290retries <value>
10291 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10293 yes | no | yes | yes
10294 Arguments :
10295 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10296 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10297 default value is 3.
10298
10299 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10300 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10301 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10302
10303 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010304 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10305 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010306
10307 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10308 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10309
10310 See also : "option redispatch"
10311
10312
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010313retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010314 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10315 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10316 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10318 yes | no | yes | yes
10319 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010320 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10321 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10322 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10323 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10324 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010325
10326 none never retry
10327
10328 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10329 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10330
10331 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10332 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10333 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10334 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10335 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10336 processing the request.
10337
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010338 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10339 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10340 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10341 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10342 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10343 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10344 overflow attack for example).
10345
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010346 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10347 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10348 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10349 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10350 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10351 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10352 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10353 amplify denial of service attacks.
10354
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010355 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10356 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10357 considered to be safe to retry.
10358
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010359 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10360 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10361 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10362 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10363 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010364
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010365 all-retryable-errors
10366 retry request for any error that are considered
10367 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10368 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10369 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10370
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010371 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10372 not cumulative.
10373
10374 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10375 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10376 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10377 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10378
10379 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10380 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10381 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10382 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10383 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10384 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10385 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10386 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10387 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10388 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10389 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10390 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10391
10392 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10393 should not use this directive.
10394
10395 The default is "conn-failure".
10396
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010397 Example:
10398 retry-on 503 504
10399
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010400 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10401
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010402server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010403 Declare a server in a backend
10404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10405 no | no | yes | yes
10406 Arguments :
10407 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010409 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010410
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010411 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10412 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10413 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10414 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010415 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10416 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010417 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010418 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10419 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010420 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10421 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10422 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10423 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10424 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10425 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10426 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010427 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010428 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10429 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10430 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10431 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10432 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10433 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10435 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010436 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10437 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010439 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010440 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10441 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10442 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10443 adding this value to the client's port.
10444
10445 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10446 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010447 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010448
10449 Examples :
10450 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10451 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010452 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010453 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10454 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10455 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010456
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010457 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10458 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10459 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10460 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10461 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10462
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010463 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10464 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010465
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010466server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010467 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010468 this backend.
10469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 no | no | yes | yes
10471
10472 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10473 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10474 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10475 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10476 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010477
10478 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10479 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10480
10481 global
10482 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10483
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010484 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010485 load-server-state-from-file
10486
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010487 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010488 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010489
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010490server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10491 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10492 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10494 no | no | yes | yes
10495
10496 Arguments:
10497 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10498
10499 <num | range>
10500 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10501 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10502 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10503 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10504
10505 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10506
10507 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10508
10509 <params*>
10510 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10511 keyword.
10512
10513 Examples:
10514 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10515 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10516 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10517
10518 # or
10519 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10520
10521 # would be equivalent to:
10522 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10523 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10524 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10525
10526
10527
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010529source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010530source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010531 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10533 yes | no | yes | yes
10534 Arguments :
10535 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10536 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010537
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010538 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010539 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10540 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10541 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10542 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10543 supported prefixes are :
10544 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10545 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10546 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010547 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010548 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10549 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010550
10551 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10552 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010553 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10554 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10555 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010556
10557 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10558 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10559 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10560 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10561 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10562 <addr>.
10563
10564 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10565 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10566 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10567 port.
10568
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010569 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10570 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10571 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10572 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010573 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010574 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10575 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10576 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10577 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10578 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10579 HTTP header.
10580
10581 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10582 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010583 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010584 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10585 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10586 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10587 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10588 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10589 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10590 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10591
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010592 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10593 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10594 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10595 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10596 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10597 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10598
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010599 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10600 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10601 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10602 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10603
10604 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10605 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10606 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10607 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10608 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10609 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10610
10611 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10612 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10613 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10614 there are two methods :
10615
10616 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10617 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10618 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10619 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10620 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10621 of the client ranges may be used.
10622
10623 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10624 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10625 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10626 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10627 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10628 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10629 same session.
10630
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010631 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10632 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10633 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010634 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010635
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010636 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10637
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010638 Examples :
10639 backend private
10640 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10641 source 192.168.1.200
10642
10643 backend transparent_ssl1
10644 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10645 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10646
10647 backend transparent_ssl2
10648 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10649 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10650 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10651
10652 backend transparent_ssl3
10653 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10654 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10655 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10656
10657 backend transparent_smtp
10658 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10659 # with Tproxy version 4.
10660 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10661
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010662 backend transparent_http
10663 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10664 # proxy.
10665 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010667 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010668 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10669
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010670
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010671srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10672 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10673 the connection on the server side.
10674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10675 yes | no | yes | yes
10676 Arguments :
10677 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10678
10679 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10680 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010681 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10682 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010683
10684 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10685
10686
10687srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10688 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10689 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10690 server side.
10691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10692 yes | no | yes | yes
10693 Arguments :
10694 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10695 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10696 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10697 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10698
10699 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10700 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010701 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10702 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010703
10704 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10705
10706
10707srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10708 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10710 yes | no | yes | yes
10711 Arguments :
10712 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10713 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10714 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10715 document.
10716
10717 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10718 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010719 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10720 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010721
10722 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10723
10724
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010725stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10726 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010728 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010729
10730 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10731 matched.
10732
10733 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10734 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10735
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010736 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10737 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10738 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10739 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010740
10741 Example :
10742 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10743 backend stats_localhost
10744 stats enable
10745 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10746
10747 Example :
10748 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10749 backend stats_auth
10750 stats enable
10751 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10752 stats admin if TRUE
10753
10754 Example :
10755 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10756 userlist stats-auth
10757 group admin users admin
10758 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10759 group readonly users haproxy
10760 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10761
10762 backend stats_auth
10763 stats enable
10764 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10765 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10766 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10767 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10768
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010769 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10770 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010771
10772
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010773stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10774 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010776 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010777 Arguments :
10778 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10779
10780 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10781
10782 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10783 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10784 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10785 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10786 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10787 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10788
10789 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10790 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10791 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010792 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010793
10794 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10795 report using "stats scope".
10796
10797 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10798 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10799 unobvious parameters.
10800
10801 Example :
10802 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10803 backend public_www
10804 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10805 stats enable
10806 stats hide-version
10807 stats scope .
10808 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010809 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010810 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10811 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10812
10813 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10814 backend private_monitoring
10815 stats enable
10816 stats uri /admin?stats
10817 stats refresh 5s
10818
10819 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10820
10821
10822stats enable
10823 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010826 Arguments : none
10827
10828 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10829 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10830 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10831 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10832 - stats auth : no authentication
10833 - stats scope : no restriction
10834
10835 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10836 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10837 unobvious parameters.
10838
10839 Example :
10840 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10841 backend public_www
10842 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10843 stats enable
10844 stats hide-version
10845 stats scope .
10846 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010847 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010848 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10849 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10850
10851 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10852 backend private_monitoring
10853 stats enable
10854 stats uri /admin?stats
10855 stats refresh 5s
10856
10857 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10858
10859
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010860stats hide-version
10861 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010863 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010864 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010865
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010866 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10867 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10868 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10869 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10870 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10871 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010873 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10874 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10875 unobvious parameters.
10876
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010877 Example :
10878 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10879 backend public_www
10880 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010881 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010882 stats hide-version
10883 stats scope .
10884 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010885 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010886 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10887 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010888
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010889 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10890 backend private_monitoring
10891 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010892 stats uri /admin?stats
10893 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010895 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010896
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010897
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010898stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10900 Access control for statistics
10901
10902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10903 no | no | yes | yes
10904
10905 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10906 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10907 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10908 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10909 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10910 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10911
10912 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10913 instance.
10914
10915 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10916 about ACL usage.
10917
10918
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010919stats realm <realm>
10920 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010922 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010923 Arguments :
10924 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10925 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10926 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10927
10928 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10929 using a backslash ('\').
10930
10931 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10932 only related to authentication.
10933
10934 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10935 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10936 unobvious parameters.
10937
10938 Example :
10939 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10940 backend public_www
10941 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10942 stats enable
10943 stats hide-version
10944 stats scope .
10945 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010947 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10948 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10949
10950 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10951 backend private_monitoring
10952 stats enable
10953 stats uri /admin?stats
10954 stats refresh 5s
10955
10956 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10957
10958
10959stats refresh <delay>
10960 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010962 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010963 Arguments :
10964 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10965 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10966 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10967 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10968 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10969 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10970
10971 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10972 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10973 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010974 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010975
10976 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10977 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10978 unobvious parameters.
10979
10980 Example :
10981 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10982 backend public_www
10983 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10984 stats enable
10985 stats hide-version
10986 stats scope .
10987 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010988 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010989 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10990 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10991
10992 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10993 backend private_monitoring
10994 stats enable
10995 stats uri /admin?stats
10996 stats refresh 5s
10997
10998 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10999
11000
11001stats scope { <name> | "." }
11002 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011004 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011005 Arguments :
11006 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11007 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11008 section in which the statement appears.
11009
11010 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11011 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11012 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11013 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11014 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11015 exists.
11016
11017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11019 unobvious parameters.
11020
11021 Example :
11022 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11023 backend public_www
11024 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11025 stats enable
11026 stats hide-version
11027 stats scope .
11028 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011030 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11031 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11032
11033 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11034 backend private_monitoring
11035 stats enable
11036 stats uri /admin?stats
11037 stats refresh 5s
11038
11039 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11040
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011042stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011043 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011046
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011047 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011048 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11049
11050 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11051 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11052
11053 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11054 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011055 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011056
11057 Example :
11058 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11059 backend private_monitoring
11060 stats enable
11061 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11062 stats uri /admin?stats
11063 stats refresh 5s
11064
11065 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11066 global section.
11067
11068
11069stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011070 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11072 yes | yes | yes | yes
11073 Arguments : none
11074
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011075 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011076 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11077 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11078 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11079 - IP (socket, server)
11080 - cookie (backend, server)
11081
11082 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11083 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011085
11086 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11087
11088
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011089stats show-modules
11090 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11092 yes | yes | yes | yes
11093 Arguments : none
11094
11095 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11096 values as a tooltip.
11097
11098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11100 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11101
11102 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11103
11104
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011105stats show-node [ <name> ]
11106 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011108 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011109 Arguments:
11110 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11111 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11112
11113 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11114 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011115 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011116
11117 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11118 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11119 unobvious parameters.
11120
11121 Example:
11122 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11123 backend private_monitoring
11124 stats enable
11125 stats show-node Europe-1
11126 stats uri /admin?stats
11127 stats refresh 5s
11128
11129 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11130 section.
11131
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011132
11133stats uri <prefix>
11134 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011136 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011137 Arguments :
11138 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11139 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11140 query string.
11141
11142 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11143 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11144 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11145 possible to reach it in the application.
11146
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011147 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011148 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011149 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11150 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11151 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11152 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11153
11154 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11155 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11156 an address or a port to statistics only.
11157
11158 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11159 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11160 unobvious parameters.
11161
11162 Example :
11163 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11164 backend public_www
11165 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11166 stats enable
11167 stats hide-version
11168 stats scope .
11169 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011170 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011171 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11172 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11173
11174 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11175 backend private_monitoring
11176 stats enable
11177 stats uri /admin?stats
11178 stats refresh 5s
11179
11180 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11181
11182
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011183stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11184 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011186 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011187
11188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011189 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011190 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011191 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11193
11194 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11195 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11196 the "stick-table" statement.
11197
11198 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11199 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11200 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11201 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11202 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11203
11204 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11205 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11206 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11207 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11208 transformation rules.
11209
11210 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11211 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11212 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11213 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11214 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11215 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11216 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11217
11218 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11219 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11220 ACL based conditions.
11221
11222 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11223 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11224 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11225 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11226
11227 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11228 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11229 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11230 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11231
11232 Example :
11233 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11234 # last 30 minutes
11235 backend pop
11236 mode tcp
11237 balance roundrobin
11238 stick store-request src
11239 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11240 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11241 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11242
11243 backend smtp
11244 mode tcp
11245 balance roundrobin
11246 stick match src table pop
11247 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11248 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11249
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011250 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11251 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011252
11253
11254stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11255 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11257 no | no | yes | yes
11258
11259 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11260 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11261 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11262 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11263
11264 Examples :
11265 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011266 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011267
11268 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11269 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11270 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11271
11272
11273 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11274 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11275 backend http
11276 mode http
11277 balance roundrobin
11278 stick on src table https
11279 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11280 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11281 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11282
11283 backend https
11284 mode tcp
11285 balance roundrobin
11286 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11287 stick on src
11288 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11289 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11290
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011291 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011292
11293
11294stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11295 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11297 no | no | yes | yes
11298
11299 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011300 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011301 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011303 server is selected.
11304
11305 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11306 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11307 the "stick-table" statement.
11308
11309 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11310 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11311 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11312 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11313 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11314 address.
11315
11316 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11317 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11318 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11319 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11320 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11321 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11322 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11323 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11324 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11325 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11326
11327 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11328 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11329 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11330 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11331 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11332 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11333 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11334
11335 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11336 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11337 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11338 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11339
11340 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11341 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11342 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11343 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11344 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11345 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011346 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11347 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11348 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11349 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11350 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11351 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011352
11353 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11354 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11355 the request.
11356
11357 Example :
11358 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11359 # last 30 minutes
11360 backend pop
11361 mode tcp
11362 balance roundrobin
11363 stick store-request src
11364 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11365 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11366 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11367
11368 backend smtp
11369 mode tcp
11370 balance roundrobin
11371 stick match src table pop
11372 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11373 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11374
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011375 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011376
11377
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011378stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011379 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011380 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011381 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011383 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011384
11385 Arguments :
11386 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11387 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11388 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11389 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11390
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011391 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11392 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11393 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11394 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11395
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011396 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11397 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11398 instance.
11399
11400 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11401 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11402 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11403 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11404 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11405 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011406 to 32 characters.
11407
11408 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11409 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11410 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011411 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011412 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11413 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011414
11415 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011416 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11417 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011418 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11419 increase.
11420
11421 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011422 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11423 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11424 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011425
11426 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011427 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011428 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11429 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011430 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011431 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11432 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11433 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11434 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11435 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11436 parameter (see below).
11437
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011438 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11439 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11440 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11441 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11442 soft restart.
11443
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011444 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11445 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11446 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11447 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011448 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011449 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011450 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11451 if not expiration delay is specified.
11452
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011453 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11454 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11455 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11456 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11457 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11458 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11459 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11460 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11461 token.
11462
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011463 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11464 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11465 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11466 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011467 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11468 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11469 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11470 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11471 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11472 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11473 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11474 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11475 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11476 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11477 types and their arguments.
11478
11479 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11480 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11481 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11482 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11483
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011484 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11485 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11486 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11487 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11488 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11489 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11490 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11491 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11492 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11493 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011494 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11495 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11496 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11497 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011498
11499 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11500 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11501 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11502 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11503 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11504 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11505 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11506 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11507 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11508 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11509 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11510 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011511 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11512 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11513 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11514 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011515
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011516 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11517 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11518 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011520
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011521 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11522 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11523 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011524 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011525 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011527
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011528 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11529 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11530 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11531 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11532
11533 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11534 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11535 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11536 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11537 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11538 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11539
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011540 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11541 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11542 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11543 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11544 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11545 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11546 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11547 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11548 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11549 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011550 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11551 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11552 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011553
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011554 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11555 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11556 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11557 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11558
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011559 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11560 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11561 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11562 they were received.
11563
11564 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11565 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11566 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11567 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11568 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11569
11570 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11571 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11572 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11573 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11574 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11575
11576 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11577 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11578 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11579
11580 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11581 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11582 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11583 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11584 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11585
11586 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11587 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11588 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11589 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11590 the client side.
11591
11592 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11593 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11595 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11596 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11597 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11598 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11599
11600 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11601 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11602 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11603 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11604 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11605 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011607
11608 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11609 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11610 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11611 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11612 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11613 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11614
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011615 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11616 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11617 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11618 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11619 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11620
11621 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11622 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11623 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11624 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11625 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11626 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11627
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011628 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011629 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011630 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11631 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11632
11633 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11634 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11636 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11637 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11638 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11639 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11640 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11641 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11642 recommended for better fairness.
11643
11644 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011645 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011646 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11647 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11648
11649 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11650 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11652 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11653 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11654 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11655 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11656 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11657 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11658 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011659
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011660 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11661 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011662 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11663 reference it.
11664
11665 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11666 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011667 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11668 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11669 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011670
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011671 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11672 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11673 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11674 something that can be ignored.
11675
11676 Example:
11677 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11678 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11679 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11680 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11681
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011682 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011683 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011684
11685
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011686stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011687 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11689 no | no | yes | yes
11690
11691 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011692 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011693 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011694 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011695 server is selected.
11696
11697 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11698 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11699 the "stick-table" statement.
11700
11701 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11702 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11703 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11704 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11705
11706 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11707 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11708 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11709 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11710 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11711 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011712 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011713 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11714 rules.
11715
11716 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11717 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11718 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11719 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11720 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11721 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11722 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11723
11724 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11725 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11726 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11727 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11728
11729 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11730 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11731 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11732 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11733 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11734 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011735 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11736 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11737 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11738 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11739 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11740 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11741 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11742 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11743 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011744
11745 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11746
11747 Example :
11748 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11749 backend https
11750 mode tcp
11751 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011752 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011753 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011754
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011755 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11756 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011757
11758 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11759 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11760 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11761
11762 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11763 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011764
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011765 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11766 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11767 # at offset 44.
11768
11769 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011770 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011771
11772 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011773 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011774
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011775 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11776 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11777
11778 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11779 extraction.
11780
11781
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011782tcp-check comment <string>
11783 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11784 it fails.
11785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11786 yes | no | yes | yes
11787
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011788 Arguments :
11789 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11790 rule fails.
11791
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011792 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11793 user-friendly error reporting.
11794
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011795 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11796 "tcp-check expect".
11797
11798
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011799tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11800 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011801 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011802 Opens a new connection
11803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011804 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011806 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011807 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11808
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011809 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011810 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011811
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011812 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011813 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11814 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011815 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011816
11817 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818
11819 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11820
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011821 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11822
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011823 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11824
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011825 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11826
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011827 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11828 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11829 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11830 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11831
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011832 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11833 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11834 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11835 haproxy -vv.
11836
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011837 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011838
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011839 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11840 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11841 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11842
11843 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11844 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11845 of the sequence.
11846
11847 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11848 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11849 do.
11850
11851 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11852 unset-var or comment rules.
11853
11854 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11856 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11857 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11858 option tcp-check
11859 tcp-check connect
11860 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11861 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11862 tcp-check send \r\n
11863 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11864 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11865 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11866 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11867 tcp-check send \r\n
11868 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11869 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11870
11871 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11872 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011873 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11875 tcp-check connect port 143
11876 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11877 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11878
11879 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11880
11881
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011882tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011883 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011884 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011885 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011888 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011889
11890 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011891 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11892
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011893 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11894 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11895 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11896 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11897 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11898 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11899 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11900 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11901 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11902 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11903
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011904 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011905 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11906 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011907 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11908 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11909 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11910
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011911 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11912 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11913 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011914 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11915 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011916 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11917 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011918 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11919 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011920 By default "L7OK" is used.
11921
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011922 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11923 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011924 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11925 supported :
11926 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11927 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011928 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11929 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11930 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11931 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11932 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011933
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011934 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011935 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011936 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11937 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11938 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11939 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011940 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11941
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011942 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11943 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11944 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11945 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11946
11947 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11948 informational message reported in logs if an error
11949 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11950 log-format string.
11951
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011952 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11953 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11954 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11955 followed by some converters.
11956
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011957 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11958 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11959 with the usual backslash ('\').
11960 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011961 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011962 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11963 used upper or lower case.
11964
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011965 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11966
11967 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11968 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11969 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11970 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11971 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11972 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11973 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11974 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11975
11976 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11977 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11978 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11979 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11980 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11981 expression.
11982
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011983 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11984 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11985 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11986 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11987 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11988 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11989
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011990 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11991 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11992 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11993 this exact hexadecimal string.
11994 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11995
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011996 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11997 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11998 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11999 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12000 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12001 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12002 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12003 size.
12004
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012005 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12006 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12007 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12008 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12009 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12010 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12011 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12012 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12013 in a binary string before matching the response's
12014 buffer.
12015
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012016 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012017 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012018 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12019 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12020 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12021 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12022 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12023 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12024 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12025 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12026 the null character.
12027
12028 Examples :
12029 # perform a POP check
12030 option tcp-check
12031 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12032
12033 # perform an IMAP check
12034 option tcp-check
12035 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12036
12037 # look for the redis master server
12038 option tcp-check
12039 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012040 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012041 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12042 tcp-check expect string role:master
12043 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12044 tcp-check expect string +OK
12045
12046
12047 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012048 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012049
12050
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012051tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12052tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12053 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12054 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012056 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012057
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012058 Arguments :
12059 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12060
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012061 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12062 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012063
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012064 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12065 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012066
12067 Examples :
12068 # look for the redis master server
12069 option tcp-check
12070 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12071 tcp-check expect string role:master
12072
12073 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012074 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012075
12076
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012077tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12078tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12079 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12080 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012082 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012083
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012084 Arguments :
12085 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012086
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012087 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12088 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012089
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012090 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12091 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12092 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012093
12094 Examples :
12095 # redis check in binary
12096 option tcp-check
12097 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12098 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12099
12100
12101 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012102 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012103
12104
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012105tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12106tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012107 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012109 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012110
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012111 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012112 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12113 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12114 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12115 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12116 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12118 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12119 and '-'.
12120
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012121 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12122 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012123 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012124 conditions.
12125
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012126 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12127
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012128 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12129 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12130
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012131 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012132 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012133 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012134
12135
12136tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012137 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012138 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012139 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012140
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012141 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012142 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12143 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12144 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12145 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12146 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12147 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12148 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12149 and '-'.
12150
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012151 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012152 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12153
12154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012155tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012156 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012158 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012159 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012160 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12161 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012163 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012164
12165 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12166 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012167 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12168 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12169 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12170 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12171 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12172 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012174 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12175 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12176 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012177 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12178 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12179 is true.
12180
12181 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12182 supported:
12183 - accept
12184 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12185 - expect-proxy layer4
12186 - reject
12187 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12188 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12189 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12190 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12191 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12192 - set-dst <expr>
12193 - set-dst-port <expr>
12194 - set-mark <mark>
12195 - set-src <expr>
12196 - set-src-port <expr>
12197 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012198 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12199 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012200 - silent-drop
12201 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12202 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12203 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012204 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012205
12206 The supported actions are described below.
12207
12208 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12209 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012210
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012211 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12212 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12213 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12214 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12215 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12216 a defaults section defining such rules.
12217
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012218 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12219 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12220 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012221
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012222 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12223 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12224 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012225
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012226 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12227 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12228 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012229
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012230 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12231 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12232 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012234 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12235 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12236 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012237
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012238 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012239
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012240 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012241
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012242 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012243
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012244 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012245
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012246tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012247
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012248 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12249 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012250
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012251tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12252 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012253
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012254 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12255 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12256 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12257 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12258 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12259 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12260 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012261
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012262tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012263
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012264 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12265 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12266 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12267 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12268 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12269 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012270
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012271tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012272
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012273 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12274 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12275 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12276 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12277 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12278 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12279 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12280 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12281 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12282 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12283 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012284
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012285tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12286tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12287tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012288
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012289 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12290 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12291 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12292 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012293
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012294tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12295 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12296tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012298
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012299 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12300 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12301 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012302
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012303tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12304tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012306 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12307 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12308 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012309
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012310tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012311
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012312 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12313 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12314 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012315
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012316tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12317tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012318
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012319 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12320 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12321 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012322
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012323tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012324
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012325 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12326 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12327 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012328
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012329tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12330tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012331
12332 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12333 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12334 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12335 for a complete description.
12336
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012337tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012338
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012339 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12340 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12341 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12342 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012343
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012344tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12345tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12346tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012347
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012348 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12349 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12350 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012351
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012352tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12353
12354 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12355 details about variables.
12356
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012358tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12359 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012361 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012363 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12364 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012366 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012368 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012369 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12370 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012371 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12372 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012374 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12375 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12376 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12377 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012378 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012379 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012380 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12381 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12382 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12383 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012384 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012385 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012386
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012387 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12388 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12389 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12390 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012391
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012392 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12393 supported:
12394 - accept
12395 - capture <sample> len <length>
12396 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12397 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012398 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012399 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012400 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012401 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012402 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012403 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012404 - set-dst <expr>
12405 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012406 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012407 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012408 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012409 - set-priority-class <expr>
12410 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012411 - set-src <expr>
12412 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012413 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012414 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12415 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012416 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012417 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012418 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12419 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12420 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012421 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012422 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012423
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012424 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012425
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012426 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12427 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12428 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12429 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12430 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12431 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012432
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012433 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12434 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12435 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12436 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12437 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12438 a defaults section defining such rules.
12439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012440 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012441 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12442 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012443
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012444 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12445 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12446 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12447 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12448 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12449 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012452 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12453 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12454 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12455 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12456 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12457 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12458 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12459 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12460 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12461 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012462
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012463 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012464 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12465 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12466 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012467
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012468 Example:
12469 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12470
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012471 Example:
12472
12473 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012474 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012475 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012476
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012477 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012478 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012479 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012480 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12481 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012482 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 tcp-request content reject
12484
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012485 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12486 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12487 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12488 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12489 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12490 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12491 ...
12492 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012494 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012495 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12496 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012497 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012498 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499
12500 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12501 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012502 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012503 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012504 tcp-request content reject
12505
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012506 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012507 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012508 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012509 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012510 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12511 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012512
12513 Example:
12514 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12515 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012516 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012519 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012520
12521 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012523 # protecting all our sites
12524 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012525 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12526 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012527 ...
12528 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12529
12530 backend http_dynamic
12531 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012532 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012533 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012534 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012535 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012536 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012537 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012539 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012540
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012541 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12542 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012543
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012544tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12545
12546 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012547 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012548
12549tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12550 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12551
12552 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12553 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12554 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12555 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12556 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12557 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12558 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12559 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12560 information.
12561
12562tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12563
12564 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12565 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12566 complete description.
12567
12568tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12569
12570 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12571 are evaluated.
12572
12573tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12574tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12575tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12576
12577 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12578 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12579 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12580 description.
12581
12582tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12583 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12584tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12585 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12586
12587 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12588 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12589 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12590
12591tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12592 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12593
12594 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12595 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12596
12597tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12598tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12599
12600 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12601 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12602 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12603
12604tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12605
12606 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12607 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12608
12609tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12610
12611 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12612 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12613 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12614
12615tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12616
12617 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12618 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12619
12620tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12621
12622 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12623 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12624
12625tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12626
12627 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12628 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12629 description.
12630
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012631tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12632tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12633
12634 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12635 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12636 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12637
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012638tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12639
12640 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12641 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12642 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12643
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012644tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12645tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012646
12647 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12648 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12649 for a complete description.
12650
12651tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12652
12653 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12654 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12655 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12656 complete description.
12657
12658tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12659 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12660
12661 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12662 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12663 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12664 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12665 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12666 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12667 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12668 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12669 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12670 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12671
12672 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12673
12674tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12675tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12676tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12677
12678 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12679 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12680 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12681
12682tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12683
12684 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12685 details about variables.
12686
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012687tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012688
12689 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12690 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12691 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12692 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12693 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12694
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012695
12696tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12697 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012699 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012700 Arguments :
12701 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12702 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12703 as explained at the top of this document.
12704
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012705 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012706 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12707 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12708 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12709 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12710
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012711 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12712 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12713 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12714 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12715
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012716 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012717 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012718 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012719 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012720 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012721 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12722 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12723 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012724
12725 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12726 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12727 it pass through unaffected.
12728
12729 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12730 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12731 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012732 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012733 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12734 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012735 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12736 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12737 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012738
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012739 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12740 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12741
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012742 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012743 "timeout client".
12744
12745
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012746tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12747 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012749 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012750 Arguments :
12751 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12752 below.
12753
12754 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12755
12756 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12757 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12758 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12759 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012760 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012761 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12762 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12763 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12764 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12765 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12766 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12767 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12768 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12769 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12770 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12771 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12772 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12773 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12774 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12775 instead.
12776
12777 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12778 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12779 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12780 rules which may be inserted.
12781
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012782 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12783 supported:
12784 - accept
12785 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012786 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12787 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12788 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12789 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12790 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012791 - set-dst <expr>
12792 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012793 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012794 - set-src <expr>
12795 - set-src-port <expr>
12796 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012797 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12798 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012799 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012800 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12801 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12802 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12803 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012804
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012805 The supported actions are described below.
12806
12807 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12808 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12809 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12810 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12811 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12812 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012813
12814 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12815 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12816 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12817
12818 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12819 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12820 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12821 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12822 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12823
12824 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12825 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12826
12827 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12828 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12829 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12830
12831 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12832 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12833 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12834
12835 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12836 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12837 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12838
12839 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12840 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12841 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12842
12843 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12844
12845 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12846
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012847tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12848
12849 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12850 rules are evaluated.
12851
12852tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12853
12854 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12855 are evaluated.
12856
12857tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12858tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12859tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12860
12861 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12862 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12863 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12864 description.
12865
12866tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12867 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12868tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12869 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12870
12871 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12872 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12873 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12874 description.
12875
12876tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12877tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12878
12879 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12880 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12881 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12882
12883tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12884
12885 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12886 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12887 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12888
12889tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12890tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12891
12892 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12893 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12894 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12895
12896tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12897
12898 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12899 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12900 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12901
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012902tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12903tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012904
12905 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12906 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12907 for a complete description.
12908
12909tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12910
12911 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12912 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12913 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12914 complete description.
12915
12916tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12917tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12918tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12919
12920 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12921 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12922 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12923
12924tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12925
12926 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12927 details about variables.
12928
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012929
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012930tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12931 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012933 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012934 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012935 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12936 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012937
12938 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12939
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012940 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012941 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12942 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012943 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12944 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012945
12946 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12947
12948 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12949 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12950 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12951 inserted.
12952
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012953 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12954 supported:
12955 - accept
12956 - close
12957 - reject
12958 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12959 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12960 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12961 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12962 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12963 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12964 - set-log-level <level>
12965 - set-mark <mark>
12966 - set-nice <nice>
12967 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012968 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12969 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012970 - silent-drop
12971 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12972
12973 The supported actions are described below.
12974
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012975 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12976 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12977 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12978 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12979 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12980 a defaults section defining such rules.
12981
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012982 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12983 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12984 for changing the default action to a reject.
12985
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012986 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012987
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012988 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12989 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12990 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12991 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
12992 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012994 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012995
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012996 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012997
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012998tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012999
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013000 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13001 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013002
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013003tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013004
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013005 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13006 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13007 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13008 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13009 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13010 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013011
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013012tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013013
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013014 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13015 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013016
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013017tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13018tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13019tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013020
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013021 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13022 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13023 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13024 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013025
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013026tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13027 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13028tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13029 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013030
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013031 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13032 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13033 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013034
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013035tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13036 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013037
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013038 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13039 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013040
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013041tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013043 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13044 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013045
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013046tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013048 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13050 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013052tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013053
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013054 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13055 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013056
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013057tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013058
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013059 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13060 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13061 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013062
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013063tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13064tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013065
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013066 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13067 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13068 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013069
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013070tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013071
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013072 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13073 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13074 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13075 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013076
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013077tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013078
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013079 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13080 details about variables.
13081
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013082
13083tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13084 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013086 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013087 Arguments :
13088 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13089 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13090 as explained at the top of this document.
13091
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013092 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13093 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013094
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013095 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13096
13097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013098timeout check <timeout>
13099 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13100 established.
13101
13102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13103 yes | no | yes | yes
13104 Arguments:
13105 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13106 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13107 as explained at the top of this document.
13108
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013109 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013110 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013111 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013112 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013113 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13114 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13115 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013117 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013118 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13119
13120 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13121 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013122 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013123
13124 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13125 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13126 forget about it.
13127
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013128 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13129 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13130
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013131 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13132 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013133
13134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013135timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013136 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13138 yes | yes | yes | no
13139 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013140 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013141 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13142 as explained at the top of this document.
13143
13144 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13145 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13146 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013147 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13148 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13149 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13150 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013151 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13152 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13153 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013154 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013155 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013156 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13157 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013158 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13159 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013160
13161 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13162 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13163 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13164 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013165 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013166 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13167
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013168 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013170
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013171timeout client-fin <timeout>
13172 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13174 yes | yes | yes | no
13175 Arguments :
13176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13178 as explained at the top of this document.
13179
13180 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13181 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13182 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13183 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13184 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13185 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13186 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013187 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13188 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13189 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013190
13191 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13192 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13193 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13194
13195 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13196
13197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013198timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013199 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13201 yes | no | yes | yes
13202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013203 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013204 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13205 as explained at the top of this document.
13206
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013207 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013208 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013209 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013210 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013211 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13212 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013213
13214 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13215 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13216 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13217 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013218 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013219 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13220
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013221 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013222
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013223
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013224timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13225 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13227 yes | yes | yes | yes
13228 Arguments :
13229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13231 as explained at the top of this document.
13232
13233 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13234 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13235 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13236 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13237 once the request has started to present itself.
13238
13239 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13240 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13241 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13242 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13243 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13244
13245 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13246 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13247 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13248 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13249
13250 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13251 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013252 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013253 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13254 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013255 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013256
13257 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13258 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13259 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13260 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13261
13262 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13263
13264
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013265timeout http-request <timeout>
13266 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013268 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013269 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13272 as explained at the top of this document.
13273
13274 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13275 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13276 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13277 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13278 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13279 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13280 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013281 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13282 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13283 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13284 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013286 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13287 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013288
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013289 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13290 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13291 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13292 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13293 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013294 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013295
13296 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13297 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013298 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013299 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13300 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13301
13302 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013303 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13304 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13305 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013306
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013307 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013308 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013309
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013310
13311timeout queue <timeout>
13312 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13314 yes | no | yes | yes
13315 Arguments :
13316 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13317 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13318 as explained at the top of this document.
13319
13320 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13321 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13322 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13323 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13324 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13325
13326 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13327 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13328 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13329 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13330
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013331 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013332
13333
13334timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013335 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13337 yes | no | yes | yes
13338 Arguments :
13339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13341 as explained at the top of this document.
13342
13343 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13344 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13345 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13346 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13347 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13348 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13349 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13350
13351 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13352 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13353 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13354 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13355 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013356 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013357 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013358 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13359 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013360 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13361 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013362
13363 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13364 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13365 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13366 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013367 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013368 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13369
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013370 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013371
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013372
13373timeout server-fin <timeout>
13374 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13376 yes | no | yes | yes
13377 Arguments :
13378 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13379 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13380 as explained at the top of this document.
13381
13382 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13383 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13384 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13385 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13386 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13387 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13388 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13389 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13390 situations, it should not be needed.
13391
13392 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13393 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13394 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13395
13396 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13397
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013398
13399timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013400 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13402 yes | yes | yes | yes
13403 Arguments :
13404 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13406 as explained at the top of this document.
13407
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013408 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13409 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13410 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013411
13412 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13413 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13414 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13415 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013416 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013417
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013418 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013419
13420
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013421timeout tunnel <timeout>
13422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13424 yes | no | yes | yes
13425 Arguments :
13426 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13427 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13428 as explained at the top of this document.
13429
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013430 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013431 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13432 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13433 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13435 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013436 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13437 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13438 specified.
13439
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013440 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13441 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13442 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13443 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13444 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13445 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13446 state.
13447
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013448 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13449 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13450 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13451 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013452 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013453
13454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13456 forget about it.
13457
13458 Example :
13459 defaults http
13460 option http-server-close
13461 timeout connect 5s
13462 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013463 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013464 timeout server 30s
13465 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13466
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013467 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013468
13469
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013470transparent (deprecated)
13471 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013473 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013474 Arguments : none
13475
13476 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13477 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13478 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13479 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13480 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13481 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13482 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13483 appropriate server.
13484
13485 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13486
13487 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13488 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13489
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013490 See also: "option transparent"
13491
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013492unique-id-format <string>
13493 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13495 yes | yes | yes | no
13496 Arguments :
13497 <string> is a log-format string.
13498
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013499 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13500 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13501 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13502 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013503
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013504 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013505 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013506 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13507 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13508 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13509 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13510 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13511 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013512
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013513 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13514 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013515
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013516 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013517
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013518 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013519
13520 will generate:
13521
13522 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13523
13524 See also: "unique-id-header"
13525
13526unique-id-header <name>
13527 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13529 yes | yes | yes | no
13530 Arguments :
13531 <name> is the name of the header.
13532
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013533 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13534 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013535
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013536 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013537
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013538 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013539 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13540
13541 will generate:
13542
13543 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13544
13545 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013546
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013547use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013548 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13550 no | yes | yes | no
13551 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013552 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13553 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013554
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013555 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13556 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013557
13558 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13559 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13560 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013561 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013562 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013563 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13564 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013565
13566 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13567 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13568 assign the backend.
13569
13570 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13571 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13572 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13573 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13574 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13575 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13576
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013577 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013578 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013579 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13580 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13581 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13582
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013583 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13584 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13585 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13586 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13587 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13588 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13589 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13590 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13591 cannot be forced from the request.
13592
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013593 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013594 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13595 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13596
13597 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13598 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013599
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013600use-fcgi-app <name>
13601 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13603 no | no | yes | yes
13604 Arguments :
13605 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13606
13607 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013608
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013609use-server <server> if <condition>
13610use-server <server> unless <condition>
13611 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13613 no | no | yes | yes
13614 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013615 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13616 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013617
13618 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13619
13620 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13621 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13622 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13623
13624 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13625 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13626 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13627 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13628 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13629 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13630 matches will assign the server.
13631
13632 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13633 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13634 with the next rules until one matches.
13635
13636 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13637 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13638 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13639 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13640
13641 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13642 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13643 stripped.
13644
13645 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13646 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013647 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013648 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013649 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013650
13651 Example :
13652 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013653 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013654 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013655 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013656 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013657 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013658 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013659 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13660 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13661
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013662 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13663 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13664 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13665 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013666 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013667 and we fall back to load balancing.
13668
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013669 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136725. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013673--------------------------
13674
13675The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13676depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13677settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13678written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13679described in this section.
13680
13681
136825.1. Bind options
13683-----------------
13684
13685The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13686as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13687no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13688parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13689while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13690provided immediately after the setting name.
13691
13692The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13693
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013694accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13695 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13696 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13697 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13698 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13699 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13700 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13701 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13702 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13703 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013704 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13705 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13706 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013708accept-proxy
13709 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013710 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13711 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013712 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13713 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13714 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13715 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013716 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013717 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13718 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013719 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13720 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013721
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013722allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013723 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013724 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013725 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013726 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13727 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013728
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013729alpn <protocols>
13730 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13731 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13732 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013733 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013734 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013735 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13736 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13737 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13738 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13739 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13740 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13741 preference, like below :
13742
13743 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013744
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013746 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013747 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13748
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013749curves <curves>
13750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13751 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13752 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13753 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13754 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13755 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13756
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013757ecdhe <named curve>
13758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013759 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13760 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013761
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013762ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13764 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020013765 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
13766 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
13767 .crl" available in the directory.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013768
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013769ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13771 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13772 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13773 error is ignored.
13774
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013775ca-sign-file <cafile>
13776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13777 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13778 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13779 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13780 'generate-certificates' for details.
13781
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013782ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13784 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13785 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13786 'generate-certificates' for details.
13787
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013788ca-verify-file <cafile>
13789 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13790 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13791 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13792 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13793 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013795ciphers <ciphers>
13796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13797 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013798 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013799 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013800 information and recommendations see e.g.
13801 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13802 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13803 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13804
13805ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13806 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13807 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13808 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13809 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013810 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13811 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013812
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013813crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13815 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013816 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13817 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013819crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13821 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13822 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13823 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13824 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013825 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13826 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013827
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013828 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13829 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13830
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013831 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13832 are loaded.
13833
13834 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013835 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13836 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13837 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13838 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13839 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13840 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13841 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013842 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013843
13844 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13845 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13846 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13847 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013848 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13849 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013850
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013851 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013852
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013854 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013855 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13856 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013857 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13858 clients).
13859
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013860 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013861 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13862 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13863 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13864 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13865 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13866 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13867 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13868 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13869 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13870 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13871 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13872 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13873
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013874 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013875 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13876 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13877 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13878 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13879
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013880 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13881 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13882 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13883 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013884
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013885 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13886 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13887 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013888
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013889crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013891 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013892 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013893 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013894
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013895crt-list <file>
13896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013897 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13898 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013899
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013900 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13901
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013902 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13903 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13904 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13905 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13906 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013907
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013908 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013909 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13910 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13911 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13912 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13913 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013914 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13915 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13916 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013917
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013918 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13919 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13920 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013921
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013922 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13923
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013924 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013925 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013926 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13927 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13928 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13929 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13930 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13931 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013932
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013933 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013934 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013935 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013936 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013937 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013938 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013940defer-accept
13941 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13942 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13943 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013944 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013945 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13946 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13947 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13948 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13949 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13950 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13951 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13952
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013953expose-fd listeners
13954 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13955 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010013956 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
13957 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013958 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013959
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013960force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013961 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013962 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013963 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013964 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013965
13966force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013967 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013968 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013969 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013970
13971force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013972 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013973 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013974 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013975
13976force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013977 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013978 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013979 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013980
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013981force-tlsv13
13982 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13983 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013984 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013985
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013986generate-certificates
13987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13988 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13989 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13990 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13991 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13992 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13993 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13994 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13995 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13996 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13997 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13998
13999 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14000 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014002 certificate is used many times.
14003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014004gid <gid>
14005 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14006 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14007 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14008 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14009 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14010
14011group <group>
14012 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14013 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14014 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14015 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14016 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14017
14018id <id>
14019 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14020 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14021 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14022 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14023
14024interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014025 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14026 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14027 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14028 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14029 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14030 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014031 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14032 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14033 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14034 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14035 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14036 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014037
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014038level <level>
14039 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14040 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14041 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014042 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014043 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14044 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14045 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014046 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014047 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014048 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014049 all counters).
14050
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014051severity-output <format>
14052 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14053 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14054 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14055 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14056 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14057 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14058 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14059 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14060 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14061 rfc5424 convention.
14062
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014063maxconn <maxconn>
14064 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14065 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14066 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14067 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14068 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14069 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14070 eat all memory.
14071
14072mode <mode>
14073 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14074 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14075 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14076 UNIX sockets.
14077
14078mss <maxseg>
14079 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14080 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14081 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14082 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14083 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14084 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14085 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14086 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14087 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14088 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14089 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14090
14091name <name>
14092 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14093 page.
14094
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014095namespace <name>
14096 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14097 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14098 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14099 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14100
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014101nice <nice>
14102 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14103 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14104 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14105 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14106 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14107 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14108 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14109 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14110 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14111 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14112 one for an RDP socket.
14113
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014114no-ca-names
14115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14116 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014117 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014118
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014119no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014120 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014121 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014122 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014123 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014124 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14125 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014126
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014127no-tls-tickets
14128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14129 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14130 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014131 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14132 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014133 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14134 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14135 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014137no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014139 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014140 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014141 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014142 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14143 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014144
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014145no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014147 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014148 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014149 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014150 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14151 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014152
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014153no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014155 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014156 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014157 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014158 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14159 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014160
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014161no-tlsv13
14162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14163 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14164 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14165 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014166 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14167 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014168
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014169npn <protocols>
14170 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14171 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14172 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014173 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014174 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014175 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14176 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14177 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14178 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14179 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014180
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014181prefer-client-ciphers
14182 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14183 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14184 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014185 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14186 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14187 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014188
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014189process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014190 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14191 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14192 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14193 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14194 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14195 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014196
14197 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14198
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014199 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014200 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14201 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14202 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14203 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14204 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014205
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014206 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14207 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14208
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014209proto <name>
14210 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14211 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14212 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014213 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14214 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14215
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014216 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14217 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14218 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014219
14220 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14221 a bind line :
14222
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014223 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014224 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14225 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14226
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014227 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014228 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014229 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014230 h2" on the bind line.
14231
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014232shards <number> | by-thread
14233 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14234 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14235 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14236 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14237 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14238 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14239 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14240 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14241 little bit.
14242
14243 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14244 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14245 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14246 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14247 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14248 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14249
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014250ssl
14251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014252 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014253 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14254 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014255 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14256 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014257
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014258ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14259 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014260 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14261 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14262 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014263 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14264
14265ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014266 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14267 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14268 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14269 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014270
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014271strict-sni
14272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14273 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14274 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14275 See the "crt" option for more information.
14276
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014277tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014278 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014279 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014280 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014281 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014282 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14283 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14284 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14285 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14286 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14287 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14288 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14289
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014290tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014291 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014292 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14293 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14294 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14295 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14296 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14297 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14298 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014299 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14300 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14301 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014302
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014303thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014304 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14305 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14306 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014307
14308 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14309 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14310 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14311 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14312 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14313 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14314 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14315 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14316 of the parsing.
14317
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014318 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014319 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14320 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014321
14322 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14323
14324 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14325 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14326 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14327 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14328 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14329 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14330
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014331tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14332 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014333 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14334 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14335 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14336 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14337 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14338 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14339 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14340 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14341 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14342 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014343 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14344 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14345
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014346transparent
14347 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14348 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14349 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14350 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14351 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14352 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14353 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14354 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14355 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14356 so check for support with your vendor.
14357
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014358v4v6
14359 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14360 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14361 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14362 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014363 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014364
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014365v6only
14366 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14367 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14368 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014369 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14370 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014372uid <uid>
14373 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14374 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14375 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14376 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14377 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14378
14379user <user>
14380 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14381 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14382 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14383 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14384 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14385
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014386verify [none|optional|required]
14387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14388 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14389 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14390 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14391 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014392 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14393 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14394 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14395 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014396
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200143975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014398------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014400The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14401which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14402arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14403settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14404after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14405Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14406address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014408 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014409 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014410
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014411Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14412keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014414The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014415
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014416addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014417 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014418 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14419 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14420 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14421 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14422 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014423
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014424agent-check
14425 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014426 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014427 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14428 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14429 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014430
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014431 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014432 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014433 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014434 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14435 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014436
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014437 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14438 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14439 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14440 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14441 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014442
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014443 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014444 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014445
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014446 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14447 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14448 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014449
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014450 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14451 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14452 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014453
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014454 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014455 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14456 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14457 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14458 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014460 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014461
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014462 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14463 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014464
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014465 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14466 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14467 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14468 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14469 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14470 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14471 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14472 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14473 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014474
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014475 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14476 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014477 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14478 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14479 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014480 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014481
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014482 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014483 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014484
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014485agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014486 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014487 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14488 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14489 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14490 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14491
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014492agent-inter <delay>
14493 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14494 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14495
14496 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14497 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14498 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14499 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14500 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14501 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14502 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14503 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14504 of backends use the same servers.
14505
14506 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14507
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014508agent-addr <addr>
14509 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14510
14511 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014512 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014513 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14514 hostname, it will be resolved.
14515
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014516agent-port <port>
14517 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14518
14519 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14520
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014521allow-0rtt
14522 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014523 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14524 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014525
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014526alpn <protocols>
14527 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14528 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14529 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014530 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014531 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14532 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14533 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14534 now obsolete NPN extension.
14535 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14536 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14537
14538 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14539
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014540 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014542backup
14543 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14544 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14545 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14546 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014547 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14548 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014549
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014550ca-file <cafile>
14551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14552 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014553 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14554 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
14555 .crl" available in the directory.
14556
14557 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14558 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14559 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014561check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014562 This option enables health checks on a server:
14563 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14564 considered available.
14565 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14566 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14567 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14568 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14569 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014570 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14571 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014572 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14573 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14574 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14575 exchanges succeed.
14576
14577 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14578 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14579 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14580 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14581 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014582 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014583 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14584
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014585 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
14586 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitely
14587 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14588 not overridden.
14589
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014590 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14591 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14592
14593 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14594 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14595
14596 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14597 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14598 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14599 available.
14600
14601 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14602 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14603 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14604
14605 Example:
14606 # simple tcp check
14607 backend foo
14608 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14609 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14610 backend foo
14611 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14612 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14613 backend foo
14614 option tcp-check
14615 tcp-check connect
14616 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014617
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014618check-send-proxy
14619 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14620 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14621 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14622 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14623 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14624 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14625 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14626
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014627check-alpn <protocols>
14628 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14629 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14630 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14631
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014632check-proto <name>
14633 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14634 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14635 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014636 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14637 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14638
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014639 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14640 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14641 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014642
14643 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14644 directive on a server line:
14645
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014646 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014647 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14648 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14649 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14650
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014651 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014652 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14653 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14654
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014655check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014656 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014657 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14658 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014659
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014660check-ssl
14661 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14662 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14663 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14664 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014665 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014666 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14667 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014668 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014669 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14670 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014671
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014672check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014673 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014674 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14675 for normal traffic.
14676
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014677ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14679 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14680 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014681 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14682 information and recommendations see e.g.
14683 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14684 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14685 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014686
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014687ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14689 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14690 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14691 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014692 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14693 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14694 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014696cookie <value>
14697 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14698 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14699 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14700 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14701 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14702 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14703 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14704
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014705crl-file <crlfile>
14706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14707 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14708 to verify server's certificate.
14709
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014710crt <cert>
14711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14712 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14713 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14714 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14715 certificate request.
14716
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014717 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14718 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14719 option is set accordingly).
14720
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014721disabled
14722 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14723 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14724 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14725 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14726 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014727 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014728
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014729enabled
14730 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14731 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14732 default value.
14733 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14734 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014736error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014737 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14738 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14739 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014741 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014743fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014744 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14745 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14746 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14747
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014748force-sslv3
14749 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14750 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014751 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014752 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014753
14754force-tlsv10
14755 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014756 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014757 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014758
14759force-tlsv11
14760 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014761 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014762 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014763
14764force-tlsv12
14765 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014766 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014767 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014768
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014769force-tlsv13
14770 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14771 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014772 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014775 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14776 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14777 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014778
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014779init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14780 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14781 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014782 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014783 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14784 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14785 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14786 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14787 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14788 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14789 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14790 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14791 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014792 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014793 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14794 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14795 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14796 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14797 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14798 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014799 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014800
14801 Example:
14802 defaults
14803 # never fail on address resolution
14804 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014806inter <delay>
14807fastinter <delay>
14808downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14810 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14811 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14812 between checks depending on the server state :
14813
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014814 Server state | Interval used
14815 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14816 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14817 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14818 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14819 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14820 or yet unchecked. |
14821 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14822 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14823 | "inter" otherwise.
14824 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014826 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14827 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14828 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14829 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014830 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14831 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14832 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14833 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14834 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014835
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014836log-proto <logproto>
14837 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14838 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14839 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14840 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014842maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014843 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14844 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014845 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14846 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014847 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14848 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14849 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14850 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14851
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014852 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14853 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14854 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14855 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14856 than 50 concurrent requests.
14857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014858maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014859 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14860 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14861 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14862 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014863 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14864 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14865 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14866 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14867 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14868 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14869 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014870
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014871max-reuse <count>
14872 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14873 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14874 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14875 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14876 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14877 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14878 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14879 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014881minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014882 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14883 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14884 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14885 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14886 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14887 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014888 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014889 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014890
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014891namespace <name>
14892 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14893 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14894 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14895 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14896
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014897no-agent-check
14898 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14899 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14900 default value.
14901 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14902 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14903
14904no-backup
14905 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14906 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14907 default value.
14908 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14909 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14910
14911no-check
14912 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14913 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14914 default value.
14915 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14916 "default-server" "check" setting.
14917
14918no-check-ssl
14919 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14920 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14921 default value.
14922 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14923 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14924
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014925no-send-proxy
14926 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14927 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14928 default value.
14929 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14930 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14931
14932no-send-proxy-v2
14933 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14934 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14935 default value.
14936 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14937 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14938
14939no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14940 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14941 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14942 default value.
14943 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14944 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14945
14946no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14947 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14948 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14949 default value.
14950 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14951 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14952
14953no-ssl
14954 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14955 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14956 default value.
14957 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14958 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14959
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014960 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14961 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14962 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14963
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014964no-ssl-reuse
14965 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14966 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14967 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14968 and for paranoid users.
14969
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014970no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014971 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14972 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014973 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014974
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014975 Supported in default-server: No
14976
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014977no-tls-tickets
14978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14979 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14980 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014981 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14982 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014983 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14984 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14985 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014986 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014987
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014988no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014989 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014990 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14991 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014992 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14993 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014994 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014995
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014996 Supported in default-server: No
14997
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014998no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014999 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015000 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15001 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015002 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15003 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015004 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015005
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015006 Supported in default-server: No
15007
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015008no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015009 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015010 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15011 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015012 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15013 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015014 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015015
15016 Supported in default-server: No
15017
15018no-tlsv13
15019 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15020 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15021 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15022 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15023 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015024 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015025
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015026 Supported in default-server: No
15027
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015028no-verifyhost
15029 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15030 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15031 default value.
15032 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15033 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015034
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015035no-tfo
15036 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15037 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15038 default value.
15039 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15040 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15041
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015042non-stick
15043 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15044 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15045 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15046
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015047npn <protocols>
15048 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15049 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15050 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015051 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015052 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15053 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15054 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015056observe <mode>
15057 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15058 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15059 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15060 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15061 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15062 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015063 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015064
15065 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015067on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015068 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15069 Currently, four modes are available:
15070 - fastinter: force fastinter
15071 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15072 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15073 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15074 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15075
15076 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15077
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015078on-marked-down <action>
15079 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15080 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015081 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15082 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15083 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15084 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15085 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15086 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15087 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15088 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015089
15090 Actions are disabled by default
15091
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015092on-marked-up <action>
15093 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15094 Currently one action is available:
15095 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15096 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15097 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15098 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015099 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15100 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015101 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15102 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15103
15104 Actions are disabled by default
15105
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015106pool-low-conn <max>
15107 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15108 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15109 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15110 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15111 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15112 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15113 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15114 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15115 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15116 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015117 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15118 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15119 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15120 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015121
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015122pool-max-conn <max>
15123 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15124 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15125 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15126 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15127 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15128 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15129
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015130pool-purge-delay <delay>
15131 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015132 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015133 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015135port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015136 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015137 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15138 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15139 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15140 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15141 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015142
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015143proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015144 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15145 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15146 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015147 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15148 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15149
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015150 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15151 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15152 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015153
15154 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15155 a server line :
15156
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015157 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015158 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15159 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15160 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15161
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015162 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015163 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15164
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015165 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015167redir <prefix>
15168 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15169 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15170 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15171 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15172 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15173 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15174 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15175 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015176 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015177 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015178 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15179 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15180 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15181 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15182
15183 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015185rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15187 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15188 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15189
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015190resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15191 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15192 server.
15193
15194 Available options:
15195
15196 * allow-dup-ip
15197 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15198 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15199 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15200 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15201 For such case, simply enable this option.
15202 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15203
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015204 * ignore-weight
15205 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15206 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15207 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15208
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015209 * prevent-dup-ip
15210 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15211 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15212 same fqdn.
15213 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15214
15215 Example:
15216 backend b_myapp
15217 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15218 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15219 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15220
15221 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15222 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15223 it
15224 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15225 different address
15226
15227 Default value: not set
15228
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229resolve-prefer <family>
15230 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15231 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15232 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15233 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15234
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015235 Default value: ipv6
15236
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015237 Example:
15238
15239 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015240
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015241resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015242 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015243 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015244 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015245 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15246 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015247 configured network, another address is selected.
15248
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015249 Example:
15250
15251 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015252
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015253resolvers <id>
15254 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15255 hostname.
15256
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015257 Example:
15258
15259 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015260
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015261 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015262
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015263send-proxy
15264 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15265 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15266 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15267 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015268 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15269 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15270 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15271 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015272 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015273 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15274 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15275 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15276 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15277 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015278 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15279 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015280
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015281send-proxy-v2
15282 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15283 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15284 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15285 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015286 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15287 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15288 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15289 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015290
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015291proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015292 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15293 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15294
15295 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15296 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15297 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15298 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15299 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15300 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15301 connection is supported).
15302 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15303 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15304 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15305 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15306 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15307 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15308 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015309
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015310send-proxy-v2-ssl
15311 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15312 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15313 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15314 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15315 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15316 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15317 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015318 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15319 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015320
15321send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15322 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15323 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15324 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15325 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15326 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15327 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15328 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15329 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015330 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15331 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015333slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015334 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15335 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15336 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15337 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15338 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15339 parameters :
15340
15341 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15342 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15343
15344 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15345 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15346 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15347 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015349 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015350 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15351 seen as failed.
15352
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015353sni <expression>
15354 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15355 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15356 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15357 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015358 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15359 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015360 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015361 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15362 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015363
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015364source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015365source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015366source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015367 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15368 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15369 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15370 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15371
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015372 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15373 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15374 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15375 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15376 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15377 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15378 server.
15379
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015380 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15381 specifying the source address without port(s).
15382
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015383ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015384 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15385 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15386 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15387 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15388 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15389 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015390 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15391 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015392
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015393ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15394 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15395 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15396 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15397
15398ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15399 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15400 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15402
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015403ssl-reuse
15404 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15405 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15406 default value.
15407 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15408 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15409
15410stick
15411 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15412 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15413 default value.
15414 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15415 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015416
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015417socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015418 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015419 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15420 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15421
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015422tcp-ut <delay>
15423 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015424 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015425 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015426 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015427 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15428 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15429 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15430 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15431 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15432 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15433 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15434 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15435 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15436
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015437tfo
15438 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15439 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15440 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15441 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015442 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015443 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015445track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015446 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15447 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15448 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15449 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015450 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15451
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015452tls-tickets
15453 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15454 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15455 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015456 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15457 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15458 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015459 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015460 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015461
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015462verify [none|required]
15463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015464 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015465 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15466 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015467 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015468 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15469 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15470 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15471 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15472 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15473 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15474 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15475 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015476
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015477verifyhost <hostname>
15478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015479 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15480 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15481 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15482 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15483 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15484 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15485 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15486 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015488weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015489 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15490 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15491 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015492 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15493 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15494 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15495 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15496 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15497 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015498
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015499ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15500 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15501 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15502 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15503
15504 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15505 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15506 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15507 server ALPN contains it.
15508
15509 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15510 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15511 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15512 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15513
15514 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15515 favor of the ALPN extension.
15516
15517 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015519
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200155205.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15521-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015522
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015523HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15524using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015525configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015526This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15527can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15528workload.
15529This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15530resolution at run time.
15531Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15532carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15533
15534
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200155355.3.1. Global overview
15536----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015537
15538As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15539different steps of the process life:
15540
15541 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15542 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15543 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15544
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015545 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15546 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015547
15548A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15549 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15550 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15551 resolution to know this new IP.
15552
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015553When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015554HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015555SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15556from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015557will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015558will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015559
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015560A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015561 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015562 first valid response.
15563
15564 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15565 servers return an error.
15566
15567
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200155685.3.2. The resolvers section
15569----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015570
15571This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015572HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15573contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015574
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020015575At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
15576no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
15577default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
15578failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
15579
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015580When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15581uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15582is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15583answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15584
15585When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015586used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015587
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015588 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15589 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15590 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015591
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015592 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15593 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015594
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015595 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015596 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15597 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015598
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015599For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15600following scenarios are possible:
15601
15602 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15603 ignored
15604
15605 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15606 applied
15607
15608 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15609 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15610
15611 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15612 retries the query with a new type
15613
15614 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15615 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015616
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015617As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015618a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015619<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015620
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015621
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015622resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015623 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015624
15625A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15626
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015627accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015628 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015629 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015630 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15631 by RFC 6891)
15632
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015633 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15634 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15635 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15636 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15637 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15638 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015639
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015640nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15641 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15642 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15643 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15644 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15645 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15646 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15647 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15648 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15649 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015650 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15651
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015652parse-resolv-conf
15653 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15654 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15655 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15656
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015657hold <status> <period>
15658 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15659 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015660 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015661 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015662 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15663 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15664 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15665
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015666 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015667
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015668resolve_retries <nb>
15669 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15670 giving up.
15671 Default value: 3
15672
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015673 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15674 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15675 type.
15676
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015677timeout <event> <time>
15678 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15679 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15680 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015681 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15682 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015683 Default value: 1s
15684 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015685 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015686 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015687 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15688 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15689
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015690 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015691
15692 resolvers mydns
15693 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15694 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015695 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015696 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015697 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015698 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015699 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015700 hold other 30s
15701 hold refused 30s
15702 hold nx 30s
15703 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015704 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015705 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015706
15707
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200157086. Cache
15709---------
15710
15711HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15712(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15713RAM.
15714
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015715The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15716blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015717
15718If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15719independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15720when we try to allocate a new one.
15721
15722The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15723
15724It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15725"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15726for more details.
15727
15728When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15729replaced by "<CACHE>".
15730
15731
157326.1. Limitation
15733----------------
15734
15735The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15736
15737- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015738- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15739 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15740 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015741- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15742- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015743- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15744 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15745 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015746- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15747 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015748- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15749 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15750 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015751
15752- If the request is not a GET
15753- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15754- If the request contains an Authorization header
15755
15756
157576.2. Setup
15758-----------
15759
15760To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15761the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15762
15763
157646.2.1. Cache section
15765---------------------
15766
15767cache <name>
15768 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15769 size of cache is mandatory.
15770
15771total-max-size <megabytes>
15772 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15773 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15774
15775max-object-size <bytes>
15776 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15777 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15778 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15779
15780max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015781 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015782 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15783 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15784 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15785 default.
15786
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015787process-vary <on/off>
15788 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015789 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15790 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15791 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015792 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015793
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015794max-secondary-entries <number>
15795 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15796 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15797 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15798
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015799
158006.2.2. Proxy section
15801---------------------
15802
15803http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15804 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15805 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15806 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15807 after this one.
15808
15809http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15810 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15811 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15812 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15813 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15814
15815
15816Example:
15817
15818 backend bck1
15819 mode http
15820
15821 http-request cache-use foobar
15822 http-response cache-store foobar
15823 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15824
15825 cache foobar
15826 total-max-size 4
15827 max-age 240
15828
15829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15831----------------------------------
15832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015833HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15835The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15836these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15837but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15838data called patterns.
15839
15840
158417.1. ACL basics
15842---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015843
15844The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15845content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15846from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15847simple :
15848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015850 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15852 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15855adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015856
15857In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015860
15861This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15862Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15863and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015864an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15865conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15866as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15867are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015868
15869ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15870'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15871which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15872
15873There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15874performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15877specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15878this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015879methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15880ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881
15882Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15883 - boolean
15884 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15885 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15886 - string
15887 - data block
15888
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015889Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15890converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15891would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15892The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15893which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15894
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015895Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15896keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15897fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15898which are summarized in the table below :
15899
15900 +---------------------+-----------------+
15901 | Sample or converter | Default |
15902 | output type | matching method |
15903 +---------------------+-----------------+
15904 | boolean | bool |
15905 +---------------------+-----------------+
15906 | integer | int |
15907 +---------------------+-----------------+
15908 | ip | ip |
15909 +---------------------+-----------------+
15910 | string | str |
15911 +---------------------+-----------------+
15912 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15913 +---------------------+-----------------+
15914
15915Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15916matching method, see below.
15917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15919 - boolean
15920 - integer or integer range
15921 - IP address / network
15922 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15923 - regular expression
15924 - hex block
15925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015926The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15927
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015928 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15929 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015931 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015932 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015933 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015934 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15937read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15938if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15939lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15940will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15941beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015942a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15944exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15945
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015946The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15947parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15948ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15949a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15950check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15951
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015952The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15953socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15954file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15957loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15958
15959 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15960
15961In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15962the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15963case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15964as well.
15965
15966The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15967sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15968do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15969methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15970is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015971obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15973default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15974that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15975string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15976
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015977The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15978By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15979string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15980resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015981server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015982waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015983flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15984function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15987sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15988be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015989
15990 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15991 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15993 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15994 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15995 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015996
15997 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15998 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016000
16001 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016003
16004 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016007 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016008 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16009
16010 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16011 binary or string samples.
16012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16014 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16017 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16018 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16021 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16024 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16027 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16030 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016031 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16034 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16035 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016036
16037For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16038request, it is possible to do :
16039
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016040 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016041
16042In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16043buffer, one would use the following acl :
16044
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016045 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016046
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016047On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16048possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16049
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016050 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16053criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16054method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
16055to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
16056criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16057the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016060the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16061For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16064 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16065 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16066 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016067
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016068
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016069The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16070types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16071combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16072brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16073default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075 +-------------------------------------------------+
16076 | Input sample type |
16077 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016078 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16080 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016082 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016084 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016086 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016088 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016090 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016092 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016094 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016096 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016098 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016100 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016102 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16104 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16105 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016106
16107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161087.1.1. Matching booleans
16109------------------------
16110
16111In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16112Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16113When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16114that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16115
16116Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16117return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16118"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161217.1.2. Matching integers
16122------------------------
16123
16124Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16125enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16126to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16127
16128Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16129matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16130lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016131
16132For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16133unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16134representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16135
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016136As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16137two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16138instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16139ranges and operators.
16140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016141For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016142operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16143Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16144of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016146Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016147
16148 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16149 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16150 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16151 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16152 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016154For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016155
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016156 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016157
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016158This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16159
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016160 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161637.1.3. Matching strings
16164-----------------------
16165
16166String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16167different forms :
16168
16169 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016170 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171
16172 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174
16175 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16176 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16177
16178 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16179 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16180
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016181 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16183 matches.
16184
16185 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16186 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16187 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016188
16189String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16190exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16191characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16192string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16193to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016194before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016195
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016196Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16197(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16198Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16199
16200Example:
16201 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16202 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162057.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16206---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016207
16208Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16209they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16210possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16211passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16212the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016213the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16214match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016215
16216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162177.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16218-------------------------------------
16219
16220It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16221not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16222a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16223to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16224digits may be used upper or lower case.
16225
16226Example :
16227 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016228 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229
16230
162317.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16232---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016233
16234IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16235netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16236within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016237host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016238difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16239at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16240does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16241parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016242
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016243The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16244abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16245
16246 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16247 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16248 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16249 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16250 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16251 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16252 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16253 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16254
16255Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16256192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16257
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016258IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16259Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16260trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16261IPv6 patterns.
16262
16263HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16264following situations :
16265 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16266 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16267 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16268 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16269 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16270 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16271 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16272 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16273 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16274 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276
162777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16278----------------------------------
16279
16280Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16281combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16282
16283 - AND (implicit)
16284 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16285 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16292indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16295"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16296requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16297is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16298
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016299 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016300 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16301 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16302 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303
16304To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16305and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16306
16307 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16308 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16309 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16310 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016312 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16314 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16315 use_backend www if host_www
16316
16317It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16318expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16319be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16320the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16321
16322 The following rule :
16323
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016324 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016325 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016326
16327 Can also be written that way :
16328
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016329 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330
16331It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16332to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16333simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16334sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16335good use is the following :
16336
16337 With named ACLs :
16338
16339 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16340 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16341 monitor fail if site_dead
16342
16343 With anonymous ACLs :
16344
16345 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16346
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016347See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16348keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349
16350
163517.3. Fetching samples
16352---------------------
16353
16354Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16355against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16356sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16357ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16358of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16359available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16360
16361This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16362Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16363compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16364deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16365
16366The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16367matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16368method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16369indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16370
16371As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16372when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16373mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16374the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16375ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16376
16377Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16378multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16379when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016380incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16381are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16383all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16384
16385Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16386 - name
16387 - name(arg1)
16388 - name(arg1,arg2)
16389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016390
163917.3.1. Converters
16392-----------------
16393
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016394Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16395of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16396is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16397was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016398has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016399unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16400
16401These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16402sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16403the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016404support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016405
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016406A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16407support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16408supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16409(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16410bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016413
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001641451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16415 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16416 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16417 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16418 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16419 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16420
16421 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016422 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16423 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016424 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16425 frontend http-in
16426 bind *:8081
16427 default_backend servers
16428 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16429 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16430
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016431add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016432 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016433 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016434 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16435 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016436 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016437 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16438 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16439 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16440 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016441 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016442 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016443
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016444add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16445 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16446 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16447 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16448 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16449 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16450 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16451 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16452 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16453 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16454 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16455 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16456 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16457 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16458 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16459 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16460 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16461 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16462 level parser. See examples below.
16463
16464 Example:
16465 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16466 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16467 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16468 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16469
16470 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16471 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16472
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016473aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16474 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16475 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16476 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16477 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16478 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16479 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16480
16481 Example:
16482 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16483 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16484
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016485and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016486 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016487 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016488 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16489 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016490 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016491 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16492 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16493 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16494 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016495 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016496 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016497
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016498b64dec
16499 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16500 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016501 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16502 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016503
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016504base64
16505 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016506 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016507 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16508 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016509
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016510be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16511 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16512 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16513 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16514 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16515 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16516
16517 Example:
16518 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16519 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16520 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16521 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16522
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016523be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16524 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16525 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16526 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16527 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16528 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16529 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16530
16531 Example:
16532 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16533 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16534 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16535 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16536
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016537bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016538 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016539 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016540 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016541 presence of a flag).
16542
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016543bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16544 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16545 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016546 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016547
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016548concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16549 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16550 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16551 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16552 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16553 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16554 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16555 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16556 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16557 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16558 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016559 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016560 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016561 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016562 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16563 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16564 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016565
16566 Example:
16567 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16568 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16569 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016570 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016571 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016572 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16573
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016574cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016575 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16576 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016577
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016578crc32([<avalanche>])
16579 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16580 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16581 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16582 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16583 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16584 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16585 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16586 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16587 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16588 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016589 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16590
16591crc32c([<avalanche>])
16592 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16593 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16594 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16595 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16596 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16597 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16598 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16599 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016600
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016601cut_crlf
16602 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16603 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16604 updated.
16605
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016606da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016607 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16608 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16609 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16610 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016611 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016612 configuration language.
16613
16614 Example:
16615 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016616 bind *:8881
16617 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016618 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016619
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016620debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16621 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16622 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16623 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16624 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16625 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16626 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16627 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16628 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16629 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16630 printable sample types.
16631
16632 Example:
16633 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016634
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016635digest(<algorithm>)
16636 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16637 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16638
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016639 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016640 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16641
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016642div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016643 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16644 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016645 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016646 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16647 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16650 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016654 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016655
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016656djb2([<avalanche>])
16657 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16658 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16659 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16660 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16661 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16662 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16663 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016664 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16665 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016666
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016667even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016668 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016669 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16670
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016671field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16672 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16673 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16674 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16675 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16676 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16677 fields.
16678
16679 Example :
16680 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16681 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16682 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16683 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16684 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016685
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016686fix_is_valid
16687 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16688 Information eXchange):
16689
16690 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16691 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016692 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016693 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016694 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016695 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16696 checksum
16697
16698 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16699 the server can be parsed.
16700
16701 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16702 message, false if not.
16703
16704 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16705
16706 Example:
16707 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16708 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16709
16710fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16711 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16712 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16713 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16714 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016715 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016716 added.
16717
16718 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16719 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16720 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16721 fix_is_valid converter.
16722
16723 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16724
16725 Example:
16726 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16727 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16728 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16729 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16730 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016732hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016733 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016734 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016735 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016736 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016737
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016738hex2i
16739 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016740 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016741
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016742htonl
16743 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16744 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16745 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16746 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16747
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016748hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016749 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16750 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16751 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16752 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016754 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016755 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16756
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016757http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016758 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16759 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016760 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16761 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16762 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16763 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16764 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16765 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16766 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16767 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016769iif(<true>,<false>)
16770 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16771 string otherwise.
16772
16773 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016774 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016775
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016776in_table(<table>)
16777 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16778 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16779 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016780 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016781 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16782
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016783ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016784 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016785 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016786 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16787 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16788 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16789 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16790 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016791
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016792json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016793 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016794 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016795 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016796 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16797 of errors:
16798 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16799 bytes, ...)
16800 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16801 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16802
16803 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16804 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16805 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16806 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16807 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16808 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016809 - "ascii" : never fails;
16810 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16811 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016812 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016813 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016814 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16815 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16816
16817 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016818 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016819
16820 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016821 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016822 capture request header user-agent len 150
16823 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016824
16825 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16826 GET / HTTP/1.0
16827 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16828
16829 Output log:
16830 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16831
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016832json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16833 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16834 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16835 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16836 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16837
16838 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16839 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16840
16841 Example:
16842 # get a integer value from the request body
16843 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16844 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16845
16846 # get a key with '.' in the name
16847 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16848 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16849
16850 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16851 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16852
16853 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16854 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16855
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016856jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16857 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16858 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16859 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16860 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16861 json_path and output_type parameters.
16862
16863 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16864 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16865
16866jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16867 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16868 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16869 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16870 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16871 json_path and output_type parameters.
16872
16873 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16874 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16875
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016876jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16877 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16878 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016879 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016880 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16881 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16882 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16883 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016884
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016885 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16886 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16887 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16888 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016889
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016890 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16891 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16892 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16893 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16894 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16895 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016896 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016897 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16898
16899 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16900 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16901 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16902 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16903 contents.
16904
16905 The possible return values are the following :
16906
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016907 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16908 | ID | message |
16909 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016910 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016911 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016912 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16913 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16914 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16915 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16916 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016917 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016918
16919 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16920 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16921
16922 Example:
16923 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16924 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16925 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16926 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16927 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16928 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16929
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016930language(<value>[,<default>])
16931 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16932 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16933 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16934 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16935 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16936 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16937 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16938 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16939 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016941 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16942 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016943
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016944 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016946 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16947 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016948
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016949 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16950 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16951 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16952 use_backend spanish if es
16953 use_backend french if fr
16954 use_backend english if en
16955 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016956
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016957length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016958 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16959 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16960 type. The result is of type integer.
16961
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016962lower
16963 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16964 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16965 type. The result is of type string.
16966
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016967ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16968 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16969 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16970 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16971 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16972 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16973 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16974
16975 Example :
16976
16977 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016978 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016979 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16980
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016981ltrim(<chars>)
16982 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16983 representation of the input sample.
16984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016985map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16986map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16987map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16988 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16989 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16990 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16991 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16992 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16993 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16994 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16995 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016997 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16998 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16999 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017000
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017001 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017002 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017004 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17005 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17006 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17007 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017008 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17009 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017010 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17011 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17012 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17013 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17014 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17015 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17016 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017018 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17020 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17022 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17024 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17025 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017026
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017027 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17028 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17029 the corresponding match text.
17030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017031 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17032 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17033 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17034 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17035 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017037 Example :
17038
17039 # this is a comment and is ignored
17040 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17041 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17042 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17043 | | | `---------- value
17044 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17045 | `---------------------------- key
17046 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17047
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017048mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017049 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17050 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017051 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017052 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017053 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017054 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17055 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17056 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17057 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017058 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017059 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017060
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017061mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017062 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17063 <packettype>.
17064 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17065 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17066 from.
17067 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17068 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17069 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17070
17071 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17072 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17073 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17074 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17075
17076 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17077 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17078 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17079 packets only):
17080 17: Session Expiry Interval
17081 33: Receive Maximum
17082 39: Maximum Packet Size
17083 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17084 25: Request Response Information
17085 23: Request Problem Information
17086 21: Authentication Method
17087 22: Authentication Data
17088 18: Will Delay Interval
17089 1: Payload Format Indicator
17090 2: Message Expiry Interval
17091 3: Content Type
17092 8: Response Topic
17093 9: Correlation Data
17094 Not supported yet:
17095 38: User Property
17096
17097 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17098 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17099 packets only):
17100 17: Session Expiry Interval
17101 33: Receive Maximum
17102 36: Maximum QoS
17103 37: Retain Available
17104 39: Maximum Packet Size
17105 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17106 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17107 31: Reason String
17108 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17109 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17110 42: Shared Subscription Available
17111 19: Server Keep Alive
17112 26: Response Information
17113 28: Server Reference
17114 21: Authentication Method
17115 22: Authentication Data
17116 Not supported yet:
17117 38: User Property
17118
17119 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17120 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17121 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17122 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17123
17124 Example:
17125
17126 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17127 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17128 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17129 if data_in_buffer
17130 # do the same as above
17131 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17132 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17133 if data_in_buffer
17134
17135mqtt_is_valid
17136 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17137
17138 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17139 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17140 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17141 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17142
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017143 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17144
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017145 Example:
17146
17147 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017148 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017149
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017150mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017151 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017152 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17153 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017154 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017155 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017156 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017157 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17158 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17159 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17160 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017161 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017162 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017163
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017164nbsrv
17165 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17166 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17167 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17168 map lookup.
17169
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017170neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017171 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17172 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17173 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17174 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017175
17176not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017177 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017178 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017180 absence of a flag).
17181
17182odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017183 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017184 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17185
17186or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017187 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017188 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017189 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17190 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17193 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17195 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017196 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017197 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017198
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017199protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17200 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17201 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17202 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17203 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17204 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17205 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17206 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17207 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17208 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17209 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17210 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17211
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017212regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017213 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17214 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17215 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17216 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17217 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17218 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17219 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17220 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17221 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017222 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17223 of characters with other ones.
17224
17225 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17226 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17227 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17228 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17229 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17230 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017231
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017232 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017233
17234 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17235 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17236 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017237 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017238
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017239 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17240 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17241
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017242 # capture groups and backreferences
17243 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017244 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017245 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17246
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017247capture-req(<id>)
17248 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17249 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17250
17251 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017252 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17253 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017254
17255capture-res(<id>)
17256 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17257 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17258
17259 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017260 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17261 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017262
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017263rtrim(<chars>)
17264 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17265 of the input sample.
17266
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017267sdbm([<avalanche>])
17268 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17269 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17270 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17271 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17272 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17273 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17274 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017275 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17276 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017277
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017278secure_memcmp(<var>)
17279 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17280 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17281 match.
17282
17283 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17284 performed in constant time.
17285
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017286 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017287 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17288
17289 Example :
17290
17291 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17292 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17293 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17294 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17295
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017296set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017297 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017298 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17299 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17300 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17301 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017305 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17307 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017308 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017309 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017310
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017311 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17312 possible conditions :
17313 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17314 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17315 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17316 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17317 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17318 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17319 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17320 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17321 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17322 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17323 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17324 called on the variable.
17325 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17326 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17327 configuration parsing.
17328 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17329 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17330 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17331 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17332 true by default.
17333
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017334sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017335 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017336 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17337
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017338sha2([<bits>])
17339 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17340 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17341
17342 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17343 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17344
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017345 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017346 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17347
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017348srv_queue
17349 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17350 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17351 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17352 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17353 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17354
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017355strcmp(<var>)
17356 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17357 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17358 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17359 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17360 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17361 shorter).
17362
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017363 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17364 strings in constant time.
17365
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017366 Example :
17367
17368 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17369 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17370 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17371
17372
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017373sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017374 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17375 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017376 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017377 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17378 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017379 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017380 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17381 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017382 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017383 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17384 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017385 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017386 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017387
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017388table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17391 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17392 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17393 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17394 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17395
17396
17397table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17398 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17399 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17400 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17401 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17402 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17403 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17404
17405table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017408 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017409 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17410 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17411
17412table_conn_cur(<table>)
17413 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17414 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17415 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17416 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17417 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17418
17419table_conn_rate(<table>)
17420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17423 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17424 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17425
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017426table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17430 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17431 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17432 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17433 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17434 data-type).
17435 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17436
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017437table_gpt0(<table>)
17438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17441 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17442 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17443
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017444table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17448 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17449 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17450 between 0 and 99.
17451 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17452 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17453 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17454 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17455
17456table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17460 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17461 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17462 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17463 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17464 value 0.
17465 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17466 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17467 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17468
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017469table_gpc0(<table>)
17470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17473 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17474 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17475
17476table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17480 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17481 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17482 sample fetch keyword.
17483
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017484table_gpc1(<table>)
17485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17487 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17488 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17489 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17490
17491table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17495 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17496 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17497 sample fetch keyword.
17498
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017499table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017502 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017503 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17504 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17505
17506table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17509 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17510 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17511 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17512 keyword.
17513
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017514table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17515 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17516 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17517 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17518 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17519 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17520
17521table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17522 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17523 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17524 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17525 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17526 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17527 keyword.
17528
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017529table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17530 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17531 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017532 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017533 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17534 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17535
17536table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17537 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17538 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17539 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17540 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17541 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17542 keyword.
17543
17544table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17545 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17546 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017547 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017548 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17549 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17550 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17551 keyword.
17552
17553table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017557 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17558 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17559 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17560 keyword.
17561
17562table_server_id(<table>)
17563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17566 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17567 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17568 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17569
17570table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17571 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17572 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017573 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017574 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17575 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17576 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17577 keyword.
17578
17579table_sess_rate(<table>)
17580 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17581 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17582 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17583 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17584 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17585 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17586 keyword.
17587
17588table_trackers(<table>)
17589 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17590 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17591 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17592 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17593 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17594 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17595 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17596 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17597 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17598 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17599
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017600ub64dec
17601 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17602 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17603 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17604
17605 Example:
17606 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17607 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17608
17609ub64enc
17610 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17611
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017612upper
17613 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17614 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17615 type. The result is of type string.
17616
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017617url_dec([<in_form>])
17618 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17619 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17620 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17621 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17622 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17623 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017624
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017625url_enc([<enc_type>])
17626 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17627 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17628 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17629 optional argument is here for future changes.
17630
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017631ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017632 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017633 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17634 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17635 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017636 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17637 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17638 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17639 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017640 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017641 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17642 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017643
17644 Example:
17645 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17646 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17647
17648 message Point {
17649 int32 latitude = 1;
17650 int32 longitude = 2;
17651 }
17652
17653 message PPoint {
17654 Point point = 59;
17655 }
17656
17657 message Rectangle {
17658 // One corner of the rectangle.
17659 PPoint lo = 48;
17660 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17661 PPoint hi = 49;
17662 }
17663
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017664 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17665 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17666 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017667
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017668 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17669 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017670 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017671 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17672
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017673 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017674
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017675 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017676
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017677 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17678 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17679 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017680
17681 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17682 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17683 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17684
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017685 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17686 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17687 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017688
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017689
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017690unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017691 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17692 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17696 response),
17697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17701
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017702utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17703 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17704 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17705 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17706 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17707 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17708 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17709
17710 Example :
17711
17712 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017713 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017714 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17715
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017716word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17717 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17718 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17719 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017720 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017721 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17722 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17723
17724 Example :
17725 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17726 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17727 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17728 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17729 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017730 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017731
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017732wt6([<avalanche>])
17733 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17734 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17735 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17736 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17737 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17738 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17739 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017740 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17741 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017742
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017743xor(<value>)
17744 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017745 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017746 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017747 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017751 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017752 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17753 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017754 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017755 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017756
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017757xxh3([<seed>])
17758 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17759 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17760 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17761 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17762 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17763 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17764 considered as cryptographically secure.
17765
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017766xxh32([<seed>])
17767 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17768 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17769 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17770 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17771 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17772 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17773 as cryptographically secure.
17774
17775xxh64([<seed>])
17776 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17777 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17778 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17779 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17780 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17781 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17782 as cryptographically secure.
17783
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017784
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786--------------------------------------------
17787
17788A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17789not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17790"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17791The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17792
17793always_false : boolean
17794 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17795 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17796
17797always_true : boolean
17798 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17799 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17800
17801avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017802 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017803 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17804 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17805 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17806 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17807 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17808 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17809 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17810 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17811 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17812 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17813 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17814 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17815 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017818 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17819 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17820 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17821 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017822 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17823
17824be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17826 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17827 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17828 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17829 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017830 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17831 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017832
17833 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17834 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17835 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17838 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17839 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17840 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017841 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17843 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017844
17845 Example :
17846 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17847 backend dynamic
17848 mode http
17849 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17850 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017852bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017853 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17854 of the string.
17855
17856bool(<bool>) : bool
17857 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17858 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17861 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017862 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17864 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017865
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017866 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017867 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017868 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17869
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017870 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17871 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017872
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017873 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017874 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017876 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017877 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017878 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017879 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017880
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017881 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17882 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017884 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017885
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017886cpu_calls : integer
17887 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17888 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17889 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17890 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17891 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17892 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17893
17894cpu_ns_avg : integer
17895 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17896 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17897 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17898 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17899 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17900 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17901 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17902 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17903 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17904 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17905 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17906
17907cpu_ns_tot : integer
17908 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17909 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17910 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17911 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17912 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17913 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17914 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17915 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17916 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17917 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17918 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17919 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17920 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17921
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017922date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017923 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017924
17925 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17926 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17927 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017928 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17929
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017930 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17931 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17932 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17933 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17934 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17935
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017936 Example :
17937
17938 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17939 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017940
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017941 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17942 # millisecond granularity
17943 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17944
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017945date_us : integer
17946 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17947 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17948 from the same timeval structure.
17949
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017950env(<name>) : string
17951 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17952 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17953 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17954 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17955 certain way.
17956
17957 Examples :
17958 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17959 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17960
17961 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017962 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17965 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017966 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17967 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17969 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017970 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17972 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017973
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017974fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17975 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17976 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17977 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17981 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17982 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17983 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17984 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17985 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17986 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17987 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017988
17989 Example :
17990 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17991 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17992 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17993 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17994 frontend mail
17995 bind :25
17996 mode tcp
17997 maxconn 100
17998 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17999 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18000 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18001 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018002
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018003hostname : string
18004 Returns the system hostname.
18005
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018006int(<integer>) : signed integer
18007 Returns a signed integer.
18008
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018009ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18010 Returns an ipv4.
18011
18012ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18013 Returns an ipv6.
18014
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018015last_rule_file: string
18016 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18017 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18018 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18019 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18020 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18021 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18022 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18023 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18024 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18025 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18026 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18027 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18028
18029last_rule_line: integer
18030 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18031 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18032 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18033 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18034 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18035 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18036 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18037 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18038 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18039 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18040 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18041 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18042
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018043lat_ns_avg : integer
18044 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18045 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18046 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18047 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18048 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18049 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18050 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18051 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18052 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018053 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18054 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18055 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18056 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18057 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18058 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018059
18060lat_ns_tot : integer
18061 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18062 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18063 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18064 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18065 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18066 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18067 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18068 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18069 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018070 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18071 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18072 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18073 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18074 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018075 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18076 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18077 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18078 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18079 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18080 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18081
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018082meth(<method>) : method
18083 Returns a method.
18084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18087 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18088 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018089 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18090 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18091 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018092
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018093prio_class : integer
18094 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18095 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18096 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18097
18098prio_offset : integer
18099 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18100 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18101 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18102 set-priority-offset".
18103
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018104proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018105 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18106 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018108queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018109 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18110 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18111 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18113 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18114 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18115 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18116 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18117
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018118rand([<range>]) : integer
18119 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18120 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18121 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18122 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18123 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18127 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18128 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18129 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18130 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018131 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18132 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18133
18134srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18135 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18136 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18137 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18138 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18139 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18140 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18141 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18142
18143 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18144 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018145
18146srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18147 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18148 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18149 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018150 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18152 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18153 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18154
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018155srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18157 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18158 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18159 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18160 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18161 fetch methods.
18162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18164 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18165 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018166 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18168 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018169 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018170 overloading servers).
18171
18172 Example :
18173 # Redirect to a separate back
18174 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18175 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18176 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18177
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018178srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018179 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18180 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18181 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18182
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018183srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018184 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18185 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18186 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18187
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018188srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018189 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18190 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18191 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18192
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018193stopping : boolean
18194 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18195 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18196 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18197
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018198str(<string>) : string
18199 Returns a string.
18200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18202 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18203 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18204
18205table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18206 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18207 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18208 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18209
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018210thread : integer
18211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18212 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18213 and debugging purposes.
18214
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018215uuid([<version>]) : string
18216 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18217 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18218 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18219
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018220var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018221 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018222 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18223 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18224 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018228 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18230 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018232 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182347.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235----------------------------------
18236
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018237The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018238closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18239methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18240sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18241TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018242the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18243counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018244"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18245used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18246can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18247Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18248table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18249tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18250currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018252bc_dst : ip
18253 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18254 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18255 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18256 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18257
18258bc_dst_port : integer
18259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018260 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018261
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018262bc_err : integer
18263 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18264 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18265 and their corresponding error message.
18266
18267bc_err_str : string
18268 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18269 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18270 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18271 corresponding error message.
18272
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018273bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018274 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18275 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18276 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18277
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018278bc_src : ip
18279 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018280 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018281 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18282 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18283
18284bc_src_port : integer
18285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018286 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018288be_id : integer
18289 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018290 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18291 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018293be_name : string
18294 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018295 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18296 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018297
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018298be_server_timeout : integer
18299 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18300 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18301 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18302
18303be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18304 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18305 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18306 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18307
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018308cur_server_timeout : integer
18309 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18310 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18311 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18312
18313cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18314 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18315 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18316 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018319 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18320 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18321 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18322 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18323 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18324 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18325 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18326 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18327 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18328 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18329 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330
18331dst_conn : integer
18332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18333 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18334 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18335 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18336 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18337 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18338 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18339 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018340
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018341dst_is_local : boolean
18342 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18343 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18344 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18345 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018346 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018347 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18348 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18349 it only once per connection.
18350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351dst_port : integer
18352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18353 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018354 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18355 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18356 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18357 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018359fc_dst : ip
18360 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18361 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18362 for details.
18363
18364fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18365 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18366 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18367 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18368
18369fc_dst_port : integer
18370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18371 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18372 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18373
18374fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018375 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18376 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18377 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018378 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018379 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18380
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018381fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018382 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018383 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018384 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018385 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18386
18387 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18388 | ID | message |
18389 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18390 | 0 | "Success" |
18391 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18392 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18393 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18394 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18395 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18396 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18397 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18398 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18399 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18400 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18401 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18402 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18403 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18404 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18405 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18406 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18407 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18408 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18409 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18410 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18411 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18412 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18413 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18414 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18415 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18416 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18417 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18418 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18419 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18420 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18421 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18422 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18423 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18424 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18425 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18426 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18427 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18428 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18429 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18430 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18431 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18432 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018433 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018434 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18435
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018436fc_fackets : integer
18437 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18438 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18439 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18440 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18441
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018442fc_http_major : integer
18443 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18444 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18445 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18446
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018447fc_lost : integer
18448 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18449 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18450 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18451 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18452
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018453fc_pp_authority : string
18454 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18455 if any.
18456
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018457fc_pp_unique_id : string
18458 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18459 if any.
18460
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018461fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18462 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18463 header.
18464
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018465fc_reordering : integer
18466 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18467 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18468 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18469 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18470
18471fc_retrans : integer
18472 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18473 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18474 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18475 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18476
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018477fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18478 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18479 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18480 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18481 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18482 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18483 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18484
18485fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18486 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18487 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18488 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18489 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18490 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18491 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18492
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018493fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018494 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18495 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18496 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18497 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18498
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018499fc_src : ip
18500 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18501 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18502 for details.
18503
18504fc_src_is_local : boolean
18505 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18506 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18507 "src_is_local" for details.
18508
18509fc_src_port : integer
18510
18511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18512 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18513 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18514
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018515
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018516fc_unacked : integer
18517 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18518 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18519 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18520 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018521
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018522fe_defbe : string
18523 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18524 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526fe_id : integer
18527 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018528 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18530
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018531fe_name : string
18532 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18533 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18534 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18535
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018536fe_client_timeout : integer
18537 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18538 current frontend.
18539
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018540sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018541sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18542sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18543sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018544 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18545 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18546 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18547
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018548sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018549sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18550sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18551sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018552 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18553 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18554 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18555
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018556sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18557 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18558 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18559 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18560 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18561 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18562 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18563 will always return zero.
18564 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18565 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018567sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018568sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18569sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18570sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018571 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18572 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018573 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18574 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18575 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018576
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018577 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018578 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18579 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018580 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18581 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18582 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018583 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18584 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18585
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018586sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18587sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18588sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18589sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18590 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18591 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18592 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18593 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18594 when a first ACL was verified.
18595
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018596sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018597sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18598sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18599sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018600 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018601 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018603sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018604sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18605sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18606sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018607 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18608 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18609 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018611sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018612sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18613sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18614sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018615 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18616 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18617 See also src_conn_rate.
18618
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018619sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18620 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18621 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18622 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18623 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18624 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18625 index, zero is returned.
18626 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18627 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18628
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018629sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018630sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18631sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18632sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018633 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018634 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018635
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018636sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18637sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18638sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18639sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18640 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18641 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18642
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018643sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18644 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18645 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18646 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18647 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18648 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18649 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18650 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18651
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018652sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18653sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18654sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18655sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18656 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18657 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18658
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018659sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18660 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18661 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18662 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18663 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18664 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18665 between 0 and 2.
18666 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18667 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18668 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18669 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18670 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018672sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018673sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18674sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18675sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018676 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18677 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18678 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018679 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18680 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18681 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018682
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018683sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18684sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18685sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18686sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18687 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18688 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18689 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18690 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18691 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18692 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18693
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018694sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018695sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18696sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18697sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018698 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018699 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18700 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018702sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018703sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18704sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18705sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018706 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18707 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18708 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18709 src_http_err_rate.
18710
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018711sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18712sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18713sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18714sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18715 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18716 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18717 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18718
18719sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18720sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18721sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18722sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18723 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18724 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18725 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18726 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018728sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018729sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18730sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18731sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018732 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018733 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18734 src_http_req_cnt.
18735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018736sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018737sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18738sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18739sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018740 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18741 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18742 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18743 src_http_req_rate.
18744
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018745sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18746 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18747 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18748 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18749 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18750 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18751 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18752 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18753 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18754 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018756sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018757sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18758sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18759sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018760 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018761 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18762 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18763 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18764 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018765
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018766 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018767 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18768 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018769 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18770
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018771sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18772sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18773sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18774sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18775 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18776 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18777 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18778 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18779 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018781sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018782sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18783sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18784sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018785 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18786 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18787 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018788
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018789sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018790sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18791sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18792sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018793 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18794 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18795 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018797sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018798sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18799sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18800sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018801 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018802 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18803 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18804 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018805 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018806 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018808sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018809sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18810sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18811sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018812 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18813 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18814 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18815 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18816 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018817 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018819sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018820sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18821sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18822sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018823 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18824 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18825 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018827sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018828sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18829sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18830sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018831 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18832 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018833 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018834 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18835 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18837 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18838 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018840so_id : integer
18841 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18842 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18843 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018844
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018845so_name : string
18846 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18847 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18848 strings instead of integers.
18849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018851 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18852 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18853 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18854 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18855 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18856 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18857 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18858 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18859 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18860 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18861 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18862 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18863 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18864 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18865 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018866
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018867 Example:
18868 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18869 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18872 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18873 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18874 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018875 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018877src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18878 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18879 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018880 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018881 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018882
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018883src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18884 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18885 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18886 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18887 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18888 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18889 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18890 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18891 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018893src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18894 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18895 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18896 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18897 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18898 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18899 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018900
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018901 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018902 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18903 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18904 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18905 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018906 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018907 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18908 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18909
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018910src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18911 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18912 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18913 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18914 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18915 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18916 was verified.
18917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018918src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018919 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018920 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018921 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018922 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018924src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018925 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18927 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018928 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018930src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18931 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18932 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18933 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018934 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018935
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018936src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18937 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18938 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18939 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18940 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18941 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18942 is returned.
18943 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18944 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18945 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018947src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018948 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018949 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018950 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018951 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018952
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018953src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18954 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18955 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18956 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18957 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18958
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018959src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18960 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18961 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18962 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18963 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18964 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18965 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18966
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018967src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18969 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18970 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18971 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18972
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018973src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18974 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18975 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18976 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18977 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18978 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18979 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18980 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18981 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18982 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18983 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018985src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018986 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18989 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018990 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18991 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18992 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018993
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018994src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18995 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18996 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18997 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18998 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18999 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19000 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19001 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019003src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019004 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019005 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019006 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019007 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019008 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19011 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19012 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19013 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19014 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019015 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019016
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019017src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19018 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19019 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019020 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019021 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19022 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19023
19024src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19025 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19026 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19027 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19028 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19029 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19030 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019033 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19035 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019036 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019038src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19039 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19040 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19041 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019042 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019043 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019044
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019045src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19046 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19047 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19048 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19049 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19050 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19051 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19052 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19053 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019055src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19056 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19057 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19058 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019059 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19061 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019062
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019063 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019064 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019065 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019066 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019067
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019068src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19069 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19070 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19071 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19072 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19073 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19074 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19075
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019076src_is_local : boolean
19077 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19078 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19079 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19080 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019081 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019082 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19083 once per connection.
19084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019085src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019086 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19087 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19088 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19089 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19090 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019093 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19094 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19095 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19096 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19097 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099src_port : integer
19100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019101 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19102 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19103 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19104 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019107 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019108 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19109 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19110 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019111 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019113src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19114 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19115 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19116 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19117 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019118 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019120src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19121 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19122 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19123 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19124 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19125 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19126 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19127 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19128 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019129
19130 Example :
19131 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19132 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19133 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19134 listen ssh
19135 bind :22
19136 mode tcp
19137 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019138 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019139 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019140 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142srv_id : integer
19143 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19144 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019145 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019146
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019147srv_name : string
19148 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19149 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019150 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019151
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191527.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019155The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19157when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19158usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019159future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019160
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001916151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19162 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19163 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19164 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19165 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19166 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19167
19168 Example :
19169 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19170 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19171 # the request.
19172 frontend http-in
19173 bind *:8081
19174 default_backend servers
19175 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19176 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19177
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019178ssl_bc : boolean
19179 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19180 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019181 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19182 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019183
19184ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19185 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019186 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19187 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019188
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019189ssl_bc_alpn : string
19190 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19191 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019192 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019193 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19194 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19195 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19196 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19197 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019198 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19199 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019200
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019201ssl_bc_cipher : string
19202 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019203 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19204 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019205
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019206ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19207 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19208 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19209 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019210 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019211
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019212ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019213 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019214 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19215 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19216 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19217 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019218 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19219 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19220 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19221
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019222ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019223 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019224 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19225 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19226 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019227
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019228ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19229 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19230 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019231 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19232 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019233
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019234ssl_bc_npn : string
19235 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19236 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019237 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019238 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19239 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19240 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19241 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019242 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19243 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019244
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019245ssl_bc_protocol : string
19246 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019247 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19248 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019249
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019250ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019251 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019252 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019253 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19254 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019255
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019256ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19257 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19258 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19259 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019260 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019261
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019262ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19263 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19264 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019265 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19266 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019267
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019268ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19269 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19270 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19271 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019272 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019273
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019274ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19275 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19277 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019279ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19280 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19281 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19282 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19283 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19284 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019286ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19287 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19288 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19289 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19290 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019291
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019292ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019293 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19294 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19295 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019296 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019297 does not support resumed sessions.
19298
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019299ssl_c_der : binary
19300 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19301 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19302 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019304ssl_c_err : integer
19305 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19306 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19307 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19308 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19309 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019310
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019311ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19313 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19314 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19315 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19316 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19317 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19318 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19319 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019320 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19321 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19322 LDAP v3.
19323 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19324 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019326ssl_c_key_alg : string
19327 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19328 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19329 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019331ssl_c_notafter : string
19332 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19333 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19334 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336ssl_c_notbefore : string
19337 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19338 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19339 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019340
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019341ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19343 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19344 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19345 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19346 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19347 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19348 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19349 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019350 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19351 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19352 LDAP v3.
19353 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19354 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019356ssl_c_serial : binary
19357 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19358 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19359 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19362 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19363 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19364 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019365 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19366 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19367
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019368 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019369 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019371ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19372 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19373 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19374 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376ssl_c_used : boolean
19377 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19378 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380ssl_c_verify : integer
19381 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19382 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19383 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19384 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019386ssl_c_version : integer
19387 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19388 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019389
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019390ssl_f_der : binary
19391 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19392 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19393 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19394
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019395ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19397 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19398 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19399 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019400 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19402 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19403 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019404 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19405 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19406 LDAP v3.
19407 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19408 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410ssl_f_key_alg : string
19411 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19412 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19413 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415ssl_f_notafter : string
19416 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19417 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19418 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420ssl_f_notbefore : string
19421 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19422 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19423 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019424
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019425ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19427 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19428 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19429 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19430 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19431 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19432 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19433 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019434 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19435 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19436 LDAP v3.
19437 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19438 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440ssl_f_serial : binary
19441 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19442 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19443 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019444
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019445ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19446 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19447 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19448 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19451 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19452 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19453 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019455ssl_f_version : integer
19456 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19457 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19458
19459ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019460 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19461 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19462 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464 Example :
19465 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19466 listen http-https
19467 bind :80
19468 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19469 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19470
19471ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19472 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19473 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19474
19475ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019476 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019478 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19480 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19481 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19482 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19483 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19484 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486ssl_fc_cipher : string
19487 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19488 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019489
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019490ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19491 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19492 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019493 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019494 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19495 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19496 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019497
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019498 Example:
19499 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19500 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19501 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19502 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19503 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19504 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19505 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19506 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19507 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19508
19509ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019510 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019511 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019512 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19513 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019514 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19515 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019516
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019517ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019518 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019519 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019520 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019521 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19522 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19523 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19524 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19525 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19526 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019527
19528ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019529 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019530 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19531 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019532
19533ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19534 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19535 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019536 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019537
19538 Example:
19539 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19540 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19541 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19542 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19543 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19544 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19545 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19546 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19547 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19548
19549ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19550 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19551 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019552 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019553 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19554 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19555 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19556
19557 Example:
19558 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19559 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19560 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19561 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19562 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19563 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19564 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19565 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19566 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19567
19568ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19569 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19570 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019571 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019572 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19573 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19574 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19575
19576 Example:
19577 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19578 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19579 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19580 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19581 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19582 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19583 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19584 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19585 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019586
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019587ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19588 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19589 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19590 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19591
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019592ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19593 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19594 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19595 transport layer.
19596 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19597 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19598 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19599 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19600
19601ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19602 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19603 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19604 transport layer.
19605 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19606 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19607 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19608 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19609
19610ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19611 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19612 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19613 transport layer.
19614 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19615 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19616 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19617 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19618
19619ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19620 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19621 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19622 transport layer.
19623 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19624 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19625 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19626 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19627
19628ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19629 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19630 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19631 transport layer.
19632 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19633 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19634 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19635 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19636
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019637ssl_fc_err : integer
19638 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19639 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19640 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19641 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19642 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19643 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19644 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19645 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19646 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19647 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19648 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19649 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19650 codes.
19651
19652ssl_fc_err_str : string
19653 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19654 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19655 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19656 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19657 also "ssl_fc_err".
19658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019659ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019660 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19661 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019662 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19663 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19664 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19665 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019666
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019667ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19668 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19669 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19670 wait until the handshake happened.
19671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19673 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019674 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19675 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019676 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019677 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019678
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019679ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019680 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019681 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19682 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019684ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019685 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019686 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19688 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19689 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19690 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19691 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19692 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694ssl_fc_protocol : string
19695 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019697
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019698ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19699 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19700 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019701 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19702 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019703
19704 Example:
19705 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19706 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19707 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19708 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19709 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19710 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19711 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19712 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19713 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19714
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019715ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019716 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019717 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019718 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019719
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019720ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19721 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19722 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19723 transport layer.
19724 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19725 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19726 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19727 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19728
19729ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19730 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19731 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19732 transport layer.
19733 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19734 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19735 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19736 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19737
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019738ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19739 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19740 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19741 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019743ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19744 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19745 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19746 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19747 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019748
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019749ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19750 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19751 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19752 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19753 BoringSSL.
19754
19755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019756ssl_fc_sni : string
19757 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19758 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019759 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019760 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19761 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19762
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019763 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019764 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019765 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019766 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019767 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019769 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019770 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19771 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019773ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19774 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19775 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019776
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019777ssl_s_der : binary
19778 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19779 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19780 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19781
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019782ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19783 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19784 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19785 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019786 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019787 does not support resumed sessions.
19788
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019789ssl_s_key_alg : string
19790 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19791 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19792 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19793
19794ssl_s_notafter : string
19795 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19796 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19797 transport layer.
19798
19799ssl_s_notbefore : string
19800 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19801 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19802 transport layer.
19803
19804ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19805 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19806 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19807 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19808 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19809 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19810 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019811 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19812 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019813 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19814 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19815 LDAP v3.
19816 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19817 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19818
19819ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19820 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19821 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19822 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19823 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19824 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19825 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019826 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19827 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019828 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19829 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19830 LDAP v3.
19831 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19832 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19833
19834ssl_s_serial : binary
19835 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19836 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19837 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19838
19839ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19840 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19841 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19842 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19843
19844ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19845 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19846 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19847 layer.
19848
19849ssl_s_version : integer
19850 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19851 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019856Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19857sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19858only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19859For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19860be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19861can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19862sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19863for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19864content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019865
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019866Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19867 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019868 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019869 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19870 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19871 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19872 sample expression). So be careful.
19873
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010019874distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
19875 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
19876 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
19877 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
19878 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
19879 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
19880 list of supported tokens.
19881
19882distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
19883 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
19884 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
19885 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
19886 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
19887 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
19888 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
19889 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
19890 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
19891 supported tokens.
19892
19893 Example :
19894 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
19895 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
19896 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
19897 # send large files to the big farm
19898 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
19899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019900payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019901 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019902 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19903 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19906 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019907 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019910req.len : integer
19911req_len : integer (deprecated)
19912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19913 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19914 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19915 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19916 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019917 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019918 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19919 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19922 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019923 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19924 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19925 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19926 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019927
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019928 ACL derivatives :
19929 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019931req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19932 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19933 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19934 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19935 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019936
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019937 ACL derivatives :
19938 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019940 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019942req.proto_http : boolean
19943req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19944 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19945 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19946 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19947 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19948 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19949 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19950 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019952 Example:
19953 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19954 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19955 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019956 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019958req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19959rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19960 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19961 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19962 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19963 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19964 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19965 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19966 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19969 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19970 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19971 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19972 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19973 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019975 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019976 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019978 Example :
19979 listen tse-farm
19980 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19981 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19982 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19983 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19984 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19985 persist rdp-cookie
19986 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19987 # This is only useful makes sense if
19988 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19989 stick-table type string size 204800
19990 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19991 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19992 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019994 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019995 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019997req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19998rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19999 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20000 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20001 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20002 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020004 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020005 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020006
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020007req.ssl_alpn : string
20008 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20009 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20010 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20011 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20012 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20013 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020014 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020015
20016 Examples :
20017 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20018 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020019 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020020 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020021 default_backend bk_default
20022
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020023req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20024 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20025 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020026 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20027 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20028 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20029 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20030 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20033req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20034 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20035 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20036 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20037 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20038 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20039 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20040 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020042req.ssl_sni : string
20043req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20044 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20045 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20046 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20047 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20048 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020049 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20050 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20051 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20052 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20053 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20054 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20055 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20056 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20057 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020059 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020060 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020062 Examples :
20063 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20064 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020065 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020066 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020067 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020068
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020069req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20070 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20071 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20072 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20073 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20074 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20075 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20076 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20077 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20078 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020080req.ssl_ver : integer
20081req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20082 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20083 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20084 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20085 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20086 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20087 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20088 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020089 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020090 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020092 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020093 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020094
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020095res.len : integer
20096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20097 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20098 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20099 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20100 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020101 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020102 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020103 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020105res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20106 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020107 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020108 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020109 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020110 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020112res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20113 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20114 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20115 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020116 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20117 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020120
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020121res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20122rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20123 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20124 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20125 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20126 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20127 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20128 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20129 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020131wait_end : boolean
20132 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20133 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020134 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020135 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20136 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020137 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020138 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20139 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020141 Examples :
20142 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20143 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20144 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020146 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20147 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20148 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20149 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20150 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20151 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20152 tcp-request content reject
20153
20154
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200201557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020156--------------------------------------
20157
20158It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20159This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20160data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20161its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20162HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20163content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20164to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20165more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20166response are indexed.
20167
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020168Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20169 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20170 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20171 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20172 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20173 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20174 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020176base : string
20177 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20178 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20179 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20180 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20181 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20182 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20183 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20184 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20185
20186 ACL derivatives :
20187 base : exact string match
20188 base_beg : prefix match
20189 base_dir : subdir match
20190 base_dom : domain match
20191 base_end : suffix match
20192 base_len : length match
20193 base_reg : regex match
20194 base_sub : substring match
20195
20196base32 : integer
20197 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20198 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20199 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020200 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20201 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20202 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020203
20204base32+src : binary
20205 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20206 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20207 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20208 per-URL counters.
20209
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020210baseq : string
20211 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20212 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20213 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20214 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20215
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020216capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20217 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20218 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20219 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20220
20221capture.req.method : string
20222 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20223 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20224 because it's allocated.
20225
20226capture.req.uri : string
20227 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20228 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20229 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20230 allocated.
20231
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020232capture.req.ver : string
20233 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20234 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20235 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20236
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020237capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20238 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20239 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20240 The first entry is an index of 0.
20241 See also: "capture response header"
20242
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020243capture.res.ver : string
20244 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20245 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20246 persistent flag.
20247
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020248req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020249 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20250 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20251 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020252
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020253req.body_param([<name>) : string
20254 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20255 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20256 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20257 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20258 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20259 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20260 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20261 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20262 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20263 given.
20264
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020265req.body_len : integer
20266 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20267 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020268 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20269 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020270
20271req.body_size : integer
20272 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020273 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20274 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020276req.cook([<name>]) : string
20277cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20278 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20279 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20280 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20281 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20282 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20283 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20284 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20285 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20286
20287 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020288 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20289 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20290 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20291 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20292 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20293 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20294 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20295 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020297req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20298cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20299 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20300 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020302req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20303cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20304 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20305 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20306 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20307 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020309cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20310 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20311 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20312 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20313 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020314 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020315 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20316 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20317 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20318 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020320hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20321 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20322 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20323 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20324 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020325 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020327req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020328 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20329 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20330 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20331 with headers such as User-Agent.
20332
20333 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20334 found.
20335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020336 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20337 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20338 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020339 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020341req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20342 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20343 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020344 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20345 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020347req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020348 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20349 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20350 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20351 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20352 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20353 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20354 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20355
20356 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20357 found.
20358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020359 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20360 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20361 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020362 with -1 being the last one.
20363
20364 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20365 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020367 ACL derivatives :
20368 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20369 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20370 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20371 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20372 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20373 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20374 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20375 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20376
20377req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20378hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20379 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20380 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020381 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20382 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20383 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20384
20385 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20386 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20387 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20388
20389 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020390
20391req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20392hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20393 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20394 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20395 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020396 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20397 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20398 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20399 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20400 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020401
20402 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20403
20404 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020405
20406req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20407hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20409 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20410 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020411
20412 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20413
20414 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020415
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020416req.hdrs : string
20417 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20418 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20419 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20420 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20421
20422req.hdrs_bin : binary
20423 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20424 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20425 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20426 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20427 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20428 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20429
20430 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020431
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020432 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20433 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020435http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20436 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20437 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20438 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20439 basic auth is supported.
20440
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020441http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20442 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20443 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20444 performed on the data sent by the client.
20445 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20446 Authorization one.
20447
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020448http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20449 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20450 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20451 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20452 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020453 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20454 basic auth is supported.
20455
20456 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020457 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20458 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20459 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20460 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020461
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020462http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020463 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20464 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20465 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020466
20467http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020468 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20469 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20470 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020471
20472http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020473 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20474 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20475 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020477http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020478 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20479 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020480 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20481 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020483method : integer + string
20484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20485 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20486 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20487 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20488 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20489 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20490 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020492 ACL derivatives :
20493 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020495 Example :
20496 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20497 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20498 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020500path : string
20501 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20502 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20503 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20504 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20505 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020506 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020507 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020509 ACL derivatives :
20510 path : exact string match
20511 path_beg : prefix match
20512 path_dir : subdir match
20513 path_dom : domain match
20514 path_end : suffix match
20515 path_len : length match
20516 path_reg : regex match
20517 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020518
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020519pathq : string
20520 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20521 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20522 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20523 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20524 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20525 result in both cases.
20526
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020527query : string
20528 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20529 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20530 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20531 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020532 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020533 which stops before the question mark.
20534
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020535req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20536 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20537 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20538 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20539 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020541req.ver : string
20542req_ver : string (deprecated)
20543 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20544 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20545 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020547 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020548 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020549
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020550res.body : binary
20551 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20552 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020553 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20554
20555 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020556
20557res.body_len : integer
20558 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20559 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020560 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20561
20562 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020563
20564res.body_size : integer
20565 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20566 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20567 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20568 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020569 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20570
20571 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020572
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020573res.cache_hit : boolean
20574 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20575 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20576
20577res.cache_name : string
20578 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20579 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20580 empty string.
20581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020582res.comp : boolean
20583 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20584 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20585 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020587res.comp_algo : string
20588 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20589 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20590 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020592res.cook([<name>]) : string
20593scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20594 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20595 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020596 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20597
20598 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020600 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020601 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020603res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20604scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20605 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20606 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020607 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20608
20609 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020611res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20612scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20613 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20614 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020615 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20616
20617 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020619res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020620 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20621 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20622
20623 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20624 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20625
20626 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20627
20628 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020630res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020631 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20632 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20633
20634 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20635 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20636
20637 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020639res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20640shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020641 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20642 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20643
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020644 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020645 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20646
20647 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020649 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020650 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20651 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20652 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20653 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20654 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20655 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20656 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20657 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020658
20659res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20660shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020661 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20662 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20663
20664 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020665 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020666
20667 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020669res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20670shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020671 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20672 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20673
20674 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20675
20676 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020677
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020678res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20679 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20680 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20681 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020682 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20683
20684 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020686res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20687shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020688 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20689 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20690
20691 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20692
20693 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020694
20695res.hdrs : string
20696 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20697 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20698 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020699 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20700
20701 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020702
20703res.hdrs_bin : binary
20704 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20705 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20706 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20707 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20708 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20709 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20710 (length of 0 for both).
20711
20712 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20713
20714 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20715 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020717res.ver : string
20718resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20719 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020720 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20721
20722 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020724 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020725 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020727set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20728 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20729 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020730 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020731 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020733 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20734 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020736status : integer
20737 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20738 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020739 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20740
20741 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020742
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020743unique-id : string
20744 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20745 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20746 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20747 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20748 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20749 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020751url : string
20752 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20753 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20754 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20755 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20756 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20757 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20758 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020760 ACL derivatives :
20761 url : exact string match
20762 url_beg : prefix match
20763 url_dir : subdir match
20764 url_dom : domain match
20765 url_end : suffix match
20766 url_len : length match
20767 url_reg : regex match
20768 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020770url_ip : ip
20771 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20772 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20773 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20774 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020775 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20776 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020778url_port : integer
20779 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020780 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020781
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020782urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20783url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020784 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20785 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020786 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20787 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20788 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20789 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020790 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20791 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020792 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20793 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020795 ACL derivatives :
20796 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20797 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20798 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20799 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20800 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20801 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20802 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20803 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020804
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020806 Example :
20807 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20808 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20809 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20810 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020811
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020812urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020813 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20814 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20815 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020816
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020817url32 : integer
20818 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20819 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20820 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20821 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20822 is an unsigned integer.
20823
20824url32+src : binary
20825 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20826 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20827 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20828
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020829
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200208307.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020831---------------------------------------
20832
20833This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20834used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20835purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20836There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20837or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20838any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20839for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20840
20841internal.htx.data : integer
20842 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20843 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20844
20845internal.htx.free : integer
20846 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20847 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20848
20849internal.htx.free_data : integer
20850 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20851 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20852
20853internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020854 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20855 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20856 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020857
20858internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20859 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20860 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20861
20862internal.htx.size : integer
20863 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20864 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20865
20866internal.htx.used : integer
20867 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20868 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20869 direction.
20870
20871internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20872 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20873 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20874 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20875 of the special value :
20876 * head : The oldest inserted block
20877 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020878 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020879
20880internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20881 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20882 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20883 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20884 integer or one of the special value :
20885 * head : The oldest inserted block
20886 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020887 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020888
20889internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20890 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20891 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20892 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20893 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20894
20895 * head : The oldest inserted block
20896 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020897 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020898
20899internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20900 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20901 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20902 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20903 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20904
20905 * head : The oldest inserted block
20906 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020907 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020908
20909internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20910 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20911 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20912 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20913 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20914
20915 * head : The oldest inserted block
20916 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020917 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020918
20919internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20920 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20921 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20922 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20923 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20924
20925 * head : The oldest inserted block
20926 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020927 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020928
20929internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20930 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20931 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20932 it returns false.
20933
20934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200209357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020936---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020938Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20939every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020940order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020942ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020943---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20944FALSE always_false never match
20945HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20946HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20947HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020948HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020949HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20950HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20951HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20952HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020020953LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020954METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20955METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20956METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20957METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20958METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20959METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20960METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20961METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20962RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20963REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20964TRUE always_true always match
20965WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20966---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020967
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209698. Logging
20970----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020972One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20973provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20974very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20975provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20976state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020977to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020978headers.
20979
20980In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20981about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20982send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20983
20984 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20985 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20986 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20987 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20988 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020989 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020990 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020991
20992The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20993allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20994as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20995while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20996real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20997delay.
20998
20999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210008.1. Log levels
21001---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021003TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021004source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021005HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21006in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21007track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21008syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21009about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021010
21011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210128.2. Log formats
21013----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021014
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021015HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021016and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21017slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21018options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021019
21020 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21021 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21022 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21023 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21024 extents.
21025
21026 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21027 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21028 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21029 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21030 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21031
21032 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21033 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21034 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21035 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21036 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21037
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021038 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21039 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21040 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21041 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21042
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021043 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021045Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21046specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21047field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21048servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21049always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21050identifier.
21051
21052Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21053 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21054 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21055 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21056 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21057
21058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210598.2.1. Default log format
21060-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021061
21062This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21063as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21064format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21065
21066 Example :
21067 listen www
21068 mode http
21069 log global
21070 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21071
21072 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21073 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21074 (www/HTTP)
21075
21076 Field Format Extract from the example above
21077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21078 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21079 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21080 4 'to' to
21081 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21082 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21083
21084Detailed fields description :
21085 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21086 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21087 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21088 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21089 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21090 and processed the connection.
21091 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21092
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021093In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21094"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21095connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021097It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21098will eventually disappear.
21099
21100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211018.2.2. TCP log format
21102---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021103
21104The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21105is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21106information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21107counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21108emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21109environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21110the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21111sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021112specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021113not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21114
21115The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21116exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021117if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021118
21119 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21120 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21121 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21122
21123A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21124are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021125
21126 Example :
21127 frontend fnt
21128 mode tcp
21129 option tcplog
21130 log global
21131 default_backend bck
21132
21133 backend bck
21134 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21135
21136 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21137 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21138 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21139
21140 Field Format Extract from the example above
21141 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21142 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21143 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21144 4 frontend_name fnt
21145 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21146 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21147 7 bytes_read* 212
21148 8 termination_state --
21149 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21150 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21151
21152Detailed fields description :
21153 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021154 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021155 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21156 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021157 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021158 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021159 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021160
21161 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021162 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21163 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21164 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021166 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21168 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021169 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21170 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21171 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21172 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021173
21174 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21175 and processed the connection.
21176
21177 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21178 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21179 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21180 applications.
21181
21182 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21183 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21184 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21185 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21186 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21187
21188 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21189 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21190 See "Timers" below for more details.
21191
21192 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21193 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21194 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21195 "Timers" below for more details.
21196
21197 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021198 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021199 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21200 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21201 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21202 details.
21203
21204 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21205 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21206 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21207 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21208 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21209
21210 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21211 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21212 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21213 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21214 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21215 for more details.
21216
21217 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021218 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021219 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21220 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21221 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021222 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021223
21224 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21225 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21226 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21227 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21228 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21229 caused by a denial of service attack.
21230
21231 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21232 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21233 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21234 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21235 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21236 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21237 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21238 denial of service attack.
21239
21240 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21241 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21242 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21243 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21244 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21245 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21246 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21247 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21248 be processed than on other servers.
21249
21250 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21251 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21252 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21253 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021254 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21256 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21257 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21258 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21259 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21260 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21261 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21262 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21263
21264 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21265 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21266 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21267 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21268 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21269 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021270 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21272
21273 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21274 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21275 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21276 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21277 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21278 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021279 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021280 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21281 occurs.
21282
21283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212848.2.3. HTTP log format
21285----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021286
21287The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21288is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21289the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21290are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21291emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21292generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21293"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21294which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021295frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21296is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021297
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021298The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21299exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021300if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021301
21302 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21303 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21304 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21305
21306And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21307this exact string:
21308
21309 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21310 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21311 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21312 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21313
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021314Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21315slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21316with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21317
21318 Example :
21319 frontend http-in
21320 mode http
21321 option httplog
21322 log global
21323 default_backend bck
21324
21325 backend static
21326 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21327
21328 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21329 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21330 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021331 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021332
21333 Field Format Extract from the example above
21334 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21335 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021336 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337 4 frontend_name http-in
21338 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021339 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021340 7 status_code 200
21341 8 bytes_read* 2750
21342 9 captured_request_cookie -
21343 10 captured_response_cookie -
21344 11 termination_state ----
21345 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21346 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21347 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21348 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21349 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021350
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021351Detailed fields description :
21352 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021353 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021354 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21355 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021356 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021357 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021358 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021359
21360 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021361 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21362 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21363 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021364
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021365 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021366 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021367
21368 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21369 and processed the connection.
21370
21371 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21372 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21373 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21374
21375 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21376 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21377 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21378 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21379 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21380 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21381
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021382 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21383 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21384 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021385 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021386 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21387 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021388 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021389 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021390
21391 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21392 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021393 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021394
21395 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21396 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021397 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21398 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399
21400 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21401 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21402 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21403 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21404 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021405 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21406 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021408 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021409 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21410 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21411 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21412 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21413 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21414 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021415 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021416
21417 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021418 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21419 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021420
21421 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21422 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021423 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021424 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21425 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21426 overflowing.
21427
21428 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21429 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21430 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21431 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21432 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21433 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21434 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21435 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21436
21437 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21438 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21439 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21440 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21441 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21442 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21443 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21444 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21445
21446 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21447 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21448 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21449 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21450 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21451 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21452 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21453
21454 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021455 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021456 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21457 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21458 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021459 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021460 system.
21461
21462 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21463 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21464 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21465 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21466 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21467 caused by a denial of service attack.
21468
21469 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21470 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21471 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21472 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21473 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21474 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21475 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21476 denial of service attack.
21477
21478 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21479 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21480 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21481 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21482 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21483 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21484 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21485 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21486 processed than on other servers.
21487
21488 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21489 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21490 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21491 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021492 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021493 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21494 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21495 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21496 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21497 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21498 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21499 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21500 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21501
21502 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21503 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21504 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21505 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21506 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21507 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021508 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021509 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21510
21511 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21512 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21513 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21514 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21515 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21516 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021517 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021518 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21519 occurs.
21520
21521 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21522 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21523 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21524 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21525 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21526 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21527 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21528 cookies" below for more details.
21529
21530 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21531 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21532 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21533 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21534 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21535 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21536 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21537 and cookies" below for more details.
21538
21539 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21540 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21541 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21542 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21543 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21544 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21545 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21546 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21547
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021548
215498.2.4. HTTPS log format
21550----------------------
21551
21552The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21553extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21554information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21555frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21556end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21557matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21558sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21559dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21560"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21561
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021562The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21563exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021564if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021565
21566 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21567 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21568 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21569 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021570 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021571
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021572This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21573appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21574HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021575
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021576 Example :
21577 frontend https-in
21578 mode http
21579 option httpslog
21580 log global
21581 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21582 default_backend bck
21583
21584 backend static
21585 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21586
21587 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21588 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21589 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021590 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21591 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021592
21593 Field Format Extract from the example above
21594 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21595 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21596 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21597 4 frontend_name https-in
21598 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21599 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21600 7 status_code 200
21601 8 bytes_read* 2750
21602 9 captured_request_cookie -
21603 10 captured_response_cookie -
21604 11 termination_state ----
21605 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21606 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21607 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21608 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21609 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021610 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021611 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021612 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21613 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021614
21615Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021616 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21617 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21618 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021619
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021620 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21621 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21622 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021623 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021624 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021625
21626 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21627 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21628 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21629 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21630
21631 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21632 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21633 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21634 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21635
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021636 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21637 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21638 can be shared by multiple requests.
21639
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021640 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21641 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21642 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21643 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21644 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21645
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021646 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21647
21648 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21649
21650
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100216518.2.5. Error log format
21652-----------------------
21653
21654When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21655protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21656unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21657line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21658"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21659will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21660logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21661
21662The default format looks like this :
21663
21664 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21665 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21666 Connection error during SSL handshake
21667
21668 Field Format Extract from the example above
21669 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21670 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21671 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21672 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21673 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21674
21675These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21676failures.
21677
21678By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21679above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21680defined format.
21681
21682An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21683source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21684number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21685internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21686error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21687the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21688certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21689indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21690indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21691ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21692are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21693would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21694regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21695
21696 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021697 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021698 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21699 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21700
21701
217028.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021703------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021704
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021705When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21706ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21707a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21708formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21709looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21710and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021711
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021712HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021713Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21714separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21715prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21716
21717Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21718variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021719("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021720
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021721If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021722as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021723less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21724the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21725
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021726Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21727"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21728delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21729preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021730
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021731Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21732'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21733https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21734such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021736Flags are :
21737 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021738 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021739 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21740 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021741
21742 Example:
21743
21744 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21745 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21746
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021747 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21748
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021749Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21750
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021751 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021752 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021753 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21754 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21755 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021756 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21757 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21758 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021759 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021760 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021761 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021762 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021763 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021764 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21765 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021766 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021767 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021768 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021769 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021770 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021771 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021772 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021773 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21774 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21775 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21776 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21777 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021778 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021779 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021780 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021781 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021782 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021783 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21784 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021785 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21786 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21787 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021788 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021789 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21790 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021791 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021792 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21793 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21794 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021795 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021796 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021797 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21798 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21799 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21800 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021801 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021802 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021803 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021804 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021805 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021806 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021807 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21808 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21809 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021810 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021811 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21812 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021813 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021814 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21815 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021816 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021817 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021818 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021819 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021820
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021821 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021822
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218248.3. Advanced logging options
21825-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021826
21827Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21828just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21829options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21830for more information about their usage.
21831
21832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218338.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21834------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021835
21836It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021837HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021838commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21839monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21840ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21841
21842 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21843 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21844 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21845 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21846
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021847 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21848 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021849
21850 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21851 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21852 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21853
21854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218558.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21856----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021857
21858The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21859what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21860or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021861"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021862just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21863log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21864after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21865is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21866with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21867with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21868
21869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218708.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21871------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021872
21873Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21874for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21875"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21876retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21877raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21878a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21879file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21880you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21881"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21882
21883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21885--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021886
21887Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21888multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21889them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21890"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21891logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21892error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21893and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21894too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21895useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21896alternative.
21897
21898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218998.4. Timing events
21900------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021901
21902Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21903reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21904the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21905frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021906mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21907addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21908
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021909Timings events in HTTP mode:
21910
21911 first request 2nd request
21912 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21913 t tr t tr ...
21914 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21915 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21916 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21917 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021918 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021919 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21920
21921Timings events in TCP mode:
21922
21923 TCP session
21924 |<----------------->|
21925 t t
21926 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21927 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21928 |<------ Tt ------->|
21929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021930 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021931 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021932 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21933 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21934 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021935 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021936 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21937 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21938 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21939 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021941 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21942 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21943 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021944 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21945 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21946 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21947 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21948 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21949 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021950
21951 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21952 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21953 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21954 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21955 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21956 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21957 request typed by hand during a test.
21958
21959 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21960 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021961 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021962 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21963 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21964 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21965 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021966
21967 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21968 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21969 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21970 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21971 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21972
21973 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21974 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21975 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21976 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21977 connection never established.
21978
21979 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21980 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21981 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21982 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21983 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21984 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21985 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21986 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21987 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21988 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21989 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021991 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21992 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21993 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21994 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21995 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21996 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21997
21998 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21999
22000 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22001 "Ta" can never be negative.
22002
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022003 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22004 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022005 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22006 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022007 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022008
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022009 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022010
22011 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022012 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22013 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022014
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022015 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22016 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22017 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22018 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22019 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22020 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22021 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22022 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022024These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22025protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22026that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022027due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22028"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22029that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022030
22031Most common cases :
22032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022033 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22034 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22035 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22036 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22037 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022038 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022039 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22040 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22041 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22042 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22043 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022044 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022045
22046 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22047 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22048 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22049 of ms on remote networks.
22050
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022051 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22052 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22053 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022054
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022055 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22056 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022057 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022058 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22059 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22060 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22061 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22062 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22063 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022064
22065Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022067 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022068 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022069 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022070
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022071 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022072 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22073 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22074
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022075 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022076 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22077 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22078 flags.
22079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022080 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22081 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022082 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22083 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22084 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22085 the client connection was maintained open.
22086
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022087 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022088 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022089 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022090 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22091
22092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220938.5. Session state at disconnection
22094-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022095
22096TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22097"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
220982-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22099each of which has a special meaning :
22100
22101 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22102 session to terminate :
22103
22104 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22105
22106 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22107 server explicitly refused it.
22108
22109 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22110 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22111 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22112 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022113 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022114
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022115 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022116 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022117
22118 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22119 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22120 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22121 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22122 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22123
22124 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22125 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22126 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22127 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22128 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022130 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022131 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22132
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022133 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022134 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22135 backup connections when going up.
22136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022137 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022139 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22140 send or receive data.
22141
22142 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22143 send or receive data.
22144
22145 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22146 with nothing left in the buffers.
22147
22148 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22149
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022150 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022151 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22152
22153 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22154 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22155 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22156 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22157 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22158
22159 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22160 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22161
22162 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22163 server (HTTP only).
22164
22165 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22166
22167 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22168 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22169 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22170
22171 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22172 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22173 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22174
22175 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22176
22177 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22178 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22179
22180 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22181 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22182 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22183
22184 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22185 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022186 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22187 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022188
22189 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22190 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22191 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22192 another server.
22193
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022194 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022195 server.
22196
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022197 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22198 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22199 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22200 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22201
22202 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22203 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22204 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22205 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22206
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022207 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22208 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22209 "use-server" rule).
22210
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022211 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22212
22213 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22214 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22215
22216 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22217
22218 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22219 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22220 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22221
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022222 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22223 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022224 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022225 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22226 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22227
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022228 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22229
22230 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22231 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22232
22233 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22234
22235 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22236
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022237The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22238was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022239helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22240starvation, attacks, etc...
22241
22242The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22243alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22244easier finding and understanding.
22245
22246 Flags Reason
22247
22248 -- Normal termination.
22249
22250 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022251 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22252 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022253 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22254
22255 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22256 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022257 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22258 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022259 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22260 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022262 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22263 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022264 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022265
22266 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22267 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22268 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22269
22270 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22271 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22272 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22273 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22274 the server takes too long to respond.
22275
22276 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22277 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22278 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22279 long a time to respond.
22280
22281 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22282 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22283 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022284 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022285 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22286 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022287
22288 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22289 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22290 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22291 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22292 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022293 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022294 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22295 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22296 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22297 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22298 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22299 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22300 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22301 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022302 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022303 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22304 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22305 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022306
22307 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22308 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022309 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22310 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22311 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22312 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022313
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022314 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022315 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22316
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022317 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022318 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22319 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022320 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022321 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22322 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22323
22324 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22325 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22326 503 or 504 here.
22327
22328 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022329 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022330 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22331 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22332 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22333
22334 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22335 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022336 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022337 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022338 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022339
22340 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22341 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22342 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22343 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22344 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22345 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022346 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022347
22348 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22349 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22350 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22351 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22352 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22353 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22354 solution is to fix the application.
22355
22356 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22357 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22358 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22359 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22360 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22361 external attacks.
22362
22363 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022364 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022365 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022366 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22367 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22368
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022369 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22370 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22371 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022372 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022373 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022375 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22376 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22377 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22378 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022379 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22380 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22381 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22382 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022383 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
22384 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
22385 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
22386 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022387
22388 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22389 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22390 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022391 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
22392 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
22393 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
22394 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022395
22396 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22397 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22398 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22399 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22400
22401 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22402 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22403 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22404 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22405
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022406The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022407persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022408important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22409re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22410
22411 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22412
22413 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22414 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22415 set on a GET request.
22416
22417 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22418 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022419 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022420 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22421
22422 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22423 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22424 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22425
22426 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22427 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22428 already got a cookie.
22429
22430 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22431 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22432 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22433 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22434 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22435
22436 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22437 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22438 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22439
22440 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22441 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22442 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22443
22444 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22445 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22446
22447 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22448 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22449 then advertised in the response.
22450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224528.6. Non-printable characters
22453-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022454
22455In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22456consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22457converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22458prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22459being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22460escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22461is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22462'}' when logging headers.
22463
22464Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22465issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22466containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22467
22468Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22469the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22470performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22471
22472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224738.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22474---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022475
22476Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22477achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022478section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022479cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22480the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22481the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022482locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022483not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22484user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22485a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22486wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22487
22488 Examples :
22489 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22490 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22491
22492 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22493 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22494
22495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22497---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022498
22499Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22500proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22501the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22502server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22503
22504Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22505response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022506section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022507
22508It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022509time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22510appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022511are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22512and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22513follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22514request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22515in the logs.
22516
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022517As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22518frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22519an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22520
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022521 Example :
22522 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22523 listen proxy-out
22524 mode http
22525 option httplog
22526 option logasap
22527 log global
22528 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22529
22530 # log the name of the virtual server
22531 capture request header Host len 20
22532
22533 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22534 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22535
22536 # log the beginning of the referrer
22537 capture request header Referer len 20
22538
22539 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22540 capture response header Server len 20
22541
22542 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22543 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22544
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022545 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022546 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22547
22548 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22549 capture response header Via len 20
22550
22551 # log the URL location during a redirection
22552 capture response header Location len 20
22553
22554 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22555 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22556 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22557 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22558 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22559
22560 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22561 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22562 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22563 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022564 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022565
22566 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22567 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22568 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22569 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22570 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022571 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022572
22573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225748.9. Examples of logs
22575---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022576
22577These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22578them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22579reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22580
22581 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22582 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22583 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22584
22585 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22586 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22587
22588 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22589 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22590 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22591
22592 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22593 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22594
22595 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22596 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22597 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22598
22599 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022600 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022601 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22602 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22603
22604 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22605 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22606 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22607
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022608 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22609 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22610 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22611 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022612 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022613 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022614
22615 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022616 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022617
22618 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22619 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22620 Nothing was sent to any server.
22621
22622 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22623 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22624
22625 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22626 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022627 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022628 send a 408 return code to the client.
22629
22630 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22631 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22632
22633 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22634 5 seconds ("c----").
22635
22636 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22637 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022638 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022639
22640 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022641 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022642 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22643 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22644 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22645 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22646 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022647
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022648
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200226499. Supported filters
22650--------------------
22651
22652Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22653accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22654unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22655
22656See also : "filter"
22657
226589.1. Trace
22659----------
22660
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022661filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022662
22663 Arguments:
22664 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22665 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22666
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022667 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022669 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022670 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22671 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22672 amount of the parsed data.
22673
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022674 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022675
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022676This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22677callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22678information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22679filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22680
22681Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22682tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22683a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22684
22685
226869.2. HTTP compression
22687---------------------
22688
22689filter compression
22690
22691The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22692keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022693when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22694fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22695done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22696explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22697filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22698listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22699order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022700
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022701See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22702 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022703
22704
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200227059.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22706--------------------------------------------
22707
22708filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22709
22710 Arguments :
22711
22712 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22713 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22714 parsed.
22715
22716 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22717 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22718 part must be placed in its own scope.
22719
22720The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22721external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022722streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022723exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22724also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22725
22726SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22727the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22728
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022729For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022730"doc/SPOE.txt".
22731
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100227329.4. Cache
22733----------
22734
22735filter cache <name>
22736
22737 Arguments :
22738
22739 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22740
22741The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22742"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022743cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022744other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22745case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22746is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22747filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022748listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22749order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022750
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022751See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22752 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22753
22754
227559.5. Fcgi-app
22756-------------
22757
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022758filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022759
22760 Arguments :
22761
22762 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22763
22764The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22765request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22766reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22767used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22768implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22769used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22770fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22771used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22772order.
22773
22774See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22775 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22776
22777
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100227789.6. OpenTracing
22779----------------
22780
22781The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22782HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22783of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22784Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22785
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022786This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022787
22788The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22789HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22790participates in the work of HAProxy.
22791
22792filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22793
22794 Arguments :
22795
22796 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22797 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22798 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22799 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22800 OpenTracing filters.
22801
22802 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22803 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22804 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22805 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22806 filter must have its own scope defined.
22807
22808More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022809of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022810
22811
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002281210. FastCGI applications
22813-------------------------
22814
22815HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22816feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22817the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22818FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22819servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22820FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22821backend.
22822
22823HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22824application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22825connection.
22826
2282710.1. Setup
22828-----------
22829
2283010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22831--------------------------
22832
22833fcgi-app <name>
22834 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22835 document root must be defined.
22836
22837acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22838 Declare or complete an access list.
22839
22840 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22841 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22842 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22843 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22844 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22845
22846docroot <path>
22847 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22848 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22849 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22850
22851index <script-name>
22852 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22853 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22854 is an optional setting.
22855
22856 Example :
22857 index index.php
22858
22859log-stderr global
22860log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022861 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022862 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22863
22864 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22865 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22866
22867pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22868 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22869 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22870 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22871
22872 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22873 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22874 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22875 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22876
22877 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22878 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22879
22880path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022881 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022882 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22883 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22884 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22885 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22886 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22887 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22888 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022889
22890 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022891 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022892 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22893 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22894 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22895 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022896
22897 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022898 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22899 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022900
22901option get-values
22902no option get-values
22903 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22904
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022905 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022906 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22907
22908 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22909 application will accept.
22910
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022911 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22912 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022913
22914 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022915 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022916 option is disabled.
22917
22918 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22919 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22920 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22921 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22922 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22923 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22924
22925option keep-conn
22926no option keep-conn
22927 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22928 sending a response.
22929
22930 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22931 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22932
22933option max-reqs <reqs>
22934 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22935 accept.
22936
22937 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22938 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22939 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22940 to 1.
22941
22942option mpxs-conns
22943no option mpxs-conns
22944 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22945
22946 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22947 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22948
22949set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22950 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22951 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22952 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22953 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22954
22955 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22956 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22957 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22958
22959 Example :
22960 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22961 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22962
22963 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22964
22965
2296610.1.2. Proxy section
22967---------------------
22968
22969use-fcgi-app <name>
22970 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22971
22972 Arguments :
22973 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22974
22975 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22976 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22977 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22978 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22979 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22980
22981 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22982 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22983 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22984 application are evaluated.
22985
22986
2298710.1.3. Example
22988---------------
22989
22990 frontend front-http
22991 mode http
22992 bind *:80
22993 bind *:
22994
22995 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22996 default_backend back-static
22997
22998 backend back-static
22999 mode http
23000 server www A.B.C.D:80
23001
23002 backend back-dynamic
23003 mode http
23004 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23005 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23006
23007 fcgi-app php-fpm
23008 log-stderr global
23009 option keep-conn
23010
23011 docroot /var/www/my-app
23012 index index.php
23013 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23014
23015
2301610.2. Default parameters
23017------------------------
23018
23019A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23020the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023021script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023022applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23023
23024 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23025 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23026 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23027 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23028 | | |
23029 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23030 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23031 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23032 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23033 | | application. |
23034 | | |
23035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23036 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23037 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23038 | | |
23039 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23040 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23041 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23042 | | the application's configuration. |
23043 | | |
23044 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23045 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23046 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23047 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23048 | | |
23049 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23050 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23051 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23052 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23053 | | be defined. |
23054 | | |
23055 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23056 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23057 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23058 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23059 | | is not set too. |
23060 | | |
23061 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23062 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23063 | | set. |
23064 | | |
23065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23066 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23067 | | the request. |
23068 | | |
23069 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23070 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23071 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23072 | | |
23073 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23074 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23075 | | script to process the request. |
23076 | | |
23077 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23078 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23079 | | |
23080 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23081 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23082 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23083 | | |
23084 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23085 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23086 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23087 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23088 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23089 | | |
23090 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23091 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23092 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23093 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23094 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23095 | | side. |
23096 | | |
23097 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23098 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23099 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23100 | | connected to. |
23101 | | |
23102 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23103 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23104 | | |
23105 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023106 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23107 | | current HAProxy version. |
23108 | | |
23109 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023110 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23111 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23112 | | |
23113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23114
23115
2311610.3. Limitations
23117------------------
23118
23119The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23120way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23121during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23122establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23123application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23124or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23125message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23126these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23127and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23128
23129Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23130request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23131requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23132
23133About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23134into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23135fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23136"http-request" ones.
23137
23138Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23139FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23140processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23141must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23142here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023143
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023144
2314511. Address formats
23146-------------------
23147
23148Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23149address.
23150
23151This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23152The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23153of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23154equivalent is '::'.
23155
23156Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23157is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23158
23159This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23160family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23161
23162Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23163configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23164use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23165'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23166
23167Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23168socket type and the transport method.
23169
23170
2317111.1 Address family prefixes
23172----------------------------
23173
23174'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23175
23176'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23177 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23178 listening.
23179
23180'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23181 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23182 on the statement using this address, a port or
23183 a port range may or must be specified.
23184
23185'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23186 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23187 using this address, a port or a port range
23188 may or must be specified.
23189
23190'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23191 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23192 using this address, a port or a port range
23193 may or must be specified.
23194
23195'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23196 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23197 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23198 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23199 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23200 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23201
23202'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23203 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23204 start by slash '/'.
23205
23206
2320711.2 Socket type prefixes
23208-------------------------
23209
23210Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23211type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23212this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23213This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23214but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23215
23216Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23217instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23218
23219If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23220they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23221report this to the maintainers.
23222
23223'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23224 to "stream"
23225
23226'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23227 to "datagram".
23228
23229
2323011.3 Protocol prefixes
23231----------------------
23232
23233'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23234 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23235 socket type and transport method is forced to
23236 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23237 this address, a port or a port range can or
23238 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23239 of 'stream+ip@'.
23240
23241'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23242 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23243 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23244 statement using this address, a port or port
23245 range can or must be specified.
23246 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23247
23248'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23249 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23250 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23251 statement using this address, a port or port
23252 range can or must be specified.
23253 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23254
23255'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23256 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23257 socket type and transport method is forced to
23258 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23259 this address, a port or a port range can or
23260 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23261 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23262
23263'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23264 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23265 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23266 the statement using this address, a port or
23267 port range can or must be specified.
23268 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23269
23270'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23271 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23272 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23273 the statement using this address, a port or
23274 port range can or must be specified.
23275 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23276
23277'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23278 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23279 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23280
23281'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23282 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23283 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23284
23285In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23286QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023288/*
23289 * Local variables:
23290 * fill-column: 79
23291 * End:
23292 */